blob: 1c42d065d9f8aeda947f957528b8e4e8a52cdcb9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6c1b6672019-02-26 16:43:49 +01007 2019/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
962 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200964nbthread <number>
965 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100966 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
967 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
968 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
969 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
970 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
971 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
976 starting the process. See also "daemon".
977
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100978presetenv <name> <value>
979 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
980 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
981 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
982 and "unsetenv".
983
984resetenv [<name> ...]
985 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
986 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
987 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
988 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
989 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
990 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
991 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
992 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
993
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100994stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200995 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
996 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
997 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
998 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
999 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1000 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001001 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001002 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1003 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1004 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1005 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001006
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001007server-state-base <directory>
1008 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001009 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1010 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001011
1012server-state-file <file>
1013 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1014 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1015 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1016 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1017 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1018 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1019 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1020 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001021 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1022 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001023
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024setenv <name> <value>
1025 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1026 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1027 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1028 and "unsetenv".
1029
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001030ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1032 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001033 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001034 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001035 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1036 information and recommendations see e.g.
1037 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1038 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1039 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1040 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001041
1042ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1043 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1044 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1045 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1046 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1047 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001048 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1049 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1050 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001051 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001052
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001053ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1055 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1056 keyword to see available options.
1057
1058 Example:
1059 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001060 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001061
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001062ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1064 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001065 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001066 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001067 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1068 information and recommendations see e.g.
1069 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1070 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1071 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1072 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1073 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001074
1075ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1077 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1078 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1079 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1080 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001081 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1082 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1083 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1084 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001085
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001086ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1088 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1089 keyword to see available options.
1090
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001091ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1093 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1094 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001095 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001096 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001097 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1098 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1099 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1100 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001101 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1102 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1103 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1104
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001105ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1106 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1107 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1108 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1109
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001110stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1111 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1112 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1113 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001114 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001115 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001116
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001117 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1118 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1119 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001120
1121stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1122 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1123 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001124 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001125
1126stats maxconn <connections>
1127 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1128 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001130uid <number>
1131 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1132 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1133 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1134 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1135
1136ulimit-n <number>
1137 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1138 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1139 option.
1140
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001141unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1142 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1143
1144 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1145 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1146 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1147 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1148 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1149 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1150 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1151 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1152 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1153 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1154
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001155unsetenv [<name> ...]
1156 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1157 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1158 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1159 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1160 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1161 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1162 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164user <user name>
1165 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1166 See also "uid" and "group".
1167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001168node <name>
1169 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1170
1171 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1172 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1173 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1174 traffic.
1175
1176description <text>
1177 Add a text that describes the instance.
1178
1179 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1180 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1181 "<" and ">" characters.
1182
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100118351degrees-data-file <file path>
1184 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001185 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000119051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1192 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1193 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1194
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001195 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001196 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1197
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001199 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1200 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1201
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
120551degrees-cache-size <number>
1206 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1207 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1208 By default, this cache is disabled.
1209
1210 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001211 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1212
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001213wurfl-data-file <file path>
1214 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1215 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1216
1217 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1218 with USE_WURFL=1.
1219
1220wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1221 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1222 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1223 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1224
1225 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1226
1227 Valid WURFL properties are:
1228 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1229
1230 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1231 device.
1232
1233 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1234 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1235
1236 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1237 particular web request.
1238
1239 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1240 used Libwurfl API version.
1241
1242 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1243 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1244 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1245
1246 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1247 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1248
1249 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1250 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1251
1252 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1253
1254 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1255
1256 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1257 with USE_WURFL=1.
1258
1259wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1260 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1261 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1262
1263 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1264 with USE_WURFL=1.
1265
1266wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1267 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1268 thus before the chroot.
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1271 with USE_WURFL=1.
1272
1273wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1274 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1275 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001277 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001278 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001279 mode is enabled by default.
1280
1281 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1282 with USE_WURFL=1.
1283
1284wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1285 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1286 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1287 - "0" : no cache is used.
1288 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1289 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1290 the highest performing option.
1291
1292 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1293 with USE_WURFL=1.
1294
1295wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1296 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1297 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013033.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304-----------------------
1305
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001306busy-polling
1307 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1308 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1309 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1310 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1311 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1312 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1313 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1314 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1315 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1316 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1317 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1318 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1319 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1320 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1321 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1322 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1323 "poll" pollers.
1324
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001325max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1326 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1327 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1328 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1329 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1330 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1331 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1332 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1333 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001335maxconn <number>
1336 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1337 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1338 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001339 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1340 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1341 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1342 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001343 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1344 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1345 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1346 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1347 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001348
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001349maxconnrate <number>
1350 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1351 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1352 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1353 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1354 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1355 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1356 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1357 fairness.
1358
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001359maxcomprate <number>
1360 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001361 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001362 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1363 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1364 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001365 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001366 default value.
1367
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001368maxcompcpuusage <number>
1369 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1370 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1371 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1372 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1373 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1374 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1375 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1376 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1377
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001378maxpipes <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1380 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1381 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1382 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1383 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1384 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1385
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001386maxsessrate <number>
1387 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1388 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1389 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1390 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1391 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1392 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1393 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1394 fairness.
1395
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001396maxsslconn <number>
1397 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1398 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1399 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1400 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1401 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1402 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1403 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001404 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1405 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1406 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1407 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1408 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1409 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1410 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001411
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001412maxsslrate <number>
1413 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1414 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1415 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1416 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1417 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1418 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1419 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1420 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1421 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1422 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1423
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001424maxzlibmem <number>
1425 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1426 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1427 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001428 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1429 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1430 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1431
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001432noepoll
1433 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1434 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001435 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
1437nokqueue
1438 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1439 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1440 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1441
1442nopoll
1443 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1444 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001445 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001446 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001448nosplice
1449 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001450 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001451 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001452 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001453 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1454 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1455 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1456 "option splice-response".
1457
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001458nogetaddrinfo
1459 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1460 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1461
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001462noreuseport
1463 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1464 command line argument "-dR".
1465
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001466profiling.tasks { on | off }
1467 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1468 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1469 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1470 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1471 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1472 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1473 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1474 CLI.
1475
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001476spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001477 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1478 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1479 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1480 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1481 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1482 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001483
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001485 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001486 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001487 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1488 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1489 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1490 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1491 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1493 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001494 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1495 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1496 openssl configuration file uses:
1497 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1498
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499ssl-mode-async
1500 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001501 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001502 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1503 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1504 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1505 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1506 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001507
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001508tune.buffers.limit <number>
1509 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1510 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1511 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1512 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1513 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001514 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001515 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1516 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1517 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1518 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1519 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1520 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1521 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1522 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1523 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1524
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001525tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1526 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1527 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1528 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1529 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1530
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001531tune.bufsize <number>
1532 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1533 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1534 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1535 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1536 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1537 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1538 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001539 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1540 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1541 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001542 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001543 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1544 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1545 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001546
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001547tune.chksize <number>
1548 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1549 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1550 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1551 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1552 checks whenever possible.
1553
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001554tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1555 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1556 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1557 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1558 this value. The default value is 1.
1559
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001560tune.fail-alloc
1561 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1562 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1563 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1564 gracefully.
1565
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001566tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1567 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1568 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1569 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1570 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1571 change it.
1572
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001573tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1574 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001575 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1576 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001577 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1578 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1579 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1580 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1581 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1582
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001583tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1584 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1585 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1586 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1587 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1588 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1589 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1590 recommended not to change this value.
1591
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001592tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1593 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1594 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1595 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1596 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1597 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1598 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1599 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1600
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001601tune.http.cookielen <number>
1602 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1603 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1604 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1605 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1606 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1607 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1608 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1609 to change this value.
1610
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001611tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001612 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1613 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001614 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001615 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001616 configuration directives too.
1617 The default value is 1024.
1618
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001619tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1620 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1621 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1622 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1623 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1624 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1625 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001626 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1627 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1628 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001629
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001630tune.idletimer <timeout>
1631 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1632 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1633 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1634 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1635 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1636 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001638 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1639 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1640
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001641tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1642 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001643 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001644 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1645 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001647 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1648 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1649
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001650tune.lua.maxmem
1651 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1652 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1653 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1654 memory.
1655
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001656tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1657 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001658 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1659 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001660 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001661
1662tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1663 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1664 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1665 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1666 check servers.
1667
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001668tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1669 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1670 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1671 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001673
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001674tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001675 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1676 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1677 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1678 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1679 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1680 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1681 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1682 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1683 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1684 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001685
1686tune.maxpollevents <number>
1687 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1688 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1689 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1690 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1691 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1692
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001693tune.maxrewrite <number>
1694 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1695 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1696 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1697 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1698 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1699 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1700 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1701 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1702 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1703 bufsize.
1704
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001705tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1706 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1707 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1708 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1709 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1710 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1711 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1712 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1713 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1714 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1715 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1716 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1717 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1718 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1719 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1720 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1721 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1722 setting this parameter to 0.
1723
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001724tune.pipesize <number>
1725 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1726 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1727 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1728 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1729 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1730 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1731
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001732tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1733tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1734 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1735 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1736 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1737 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001738 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001739 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1740 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1741
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001742tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001743 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001744 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1745 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1746 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1747 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1748
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001749tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1750 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1751 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1752 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1753
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001754tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1755tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1756 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1757 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1758 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1759 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001760 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001761 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1762 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1763 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1764 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1765 notifying haproxy again.
1766
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001767tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001768 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1769 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1770 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001771 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001772 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001774 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1775 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1776 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001777 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1778 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001779
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001780tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001781 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001782 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1783 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1784 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1785 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1786 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1787
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001788tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1789 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001790 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001791 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1792 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1793 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1794 being used for too long.
1795
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001796tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1797 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1798 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1799 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1800 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1801 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1802 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1803 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1804 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1805 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1806 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001807 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001808 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001809
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001810tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1811 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1812 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1813 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1814 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1815 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1816 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1817 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001818 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1819 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001820
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001821tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1822 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1823 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1824 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1825 1000 entries.
1826
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001827tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1828 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1829 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1830 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1831
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001832tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001833tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001834tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1835tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1836tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001837 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1838 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1839 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1840 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1841 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1842 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1843 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1844 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001845
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001846 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1847 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1848 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1849 all available space is consumed.
1850 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1851 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1852 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001853
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001854tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1855 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001856 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001857 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001858 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001859 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1860
1861tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1862 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1863 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001864 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1865 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018673.3. Debugging
1868--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001869
1870debug
1871 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1872 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1873 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1874 system startup.
1875
1876quiet
1877 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1878 line argument "-q".
1879
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018813.4. Userlists
1882--------------
1883It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1884http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1885it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1886
1887userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001888 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001889 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1890
1891group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001892 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001893 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1894 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1895
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001896user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1897 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001898 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1899 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001900 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1901 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1902 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1903 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001904
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001905 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1906 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1907 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1908 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1909 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1910 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1911 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1912 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1913 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001914
1915 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001916 userlist L1
1917 group G1 users tiger,scott
1918 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001920 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1921 user scott insecure-password elgato
1922 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001923
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001924 userlist L2
1925 group G1
1926 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001927
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001928 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1929 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1930 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001931
1932 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001933
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001934
19353.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001936----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001937It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1938several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1939instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1940values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1941automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1942In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1943using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1944tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1945reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1946Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1947that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1948each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001949
1950peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001951 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001952 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1953
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001954bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1955 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1956 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1957
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001958disabled
1959 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1960 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1961 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1962
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001963default-bind [param*]
1964 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1965
1966default-server [param*]
1967 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1968
1969 Arguments:
1970 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1971 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1972 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1973 details.
1974
1975
1976 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1977
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001978enable
1979 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1980
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001981peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001982 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1983 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1984 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1985 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1986 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1987 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1988
1989 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1990 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1991
1992 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1993 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1994 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1995 across all peers.
1996
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001997 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1998 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001999
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002000 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2001 "server" keyword explanation below).
2002
2003server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2004 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2005 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2006 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2007 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2008 of this "peers" section).
2009 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2010
2011
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002012 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002013 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002014 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002015 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2016 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2017 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
2019 backend mybackend
2020 mode tcp
2021 balance roundrobin
2022 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2023 stick on src
2024
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002025 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2026 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002027
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002028 Example:
2029 peers mypeers
2030 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2031 default-server ssl verify none
2032 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2033 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002034
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020353.6. Mailers
2036------------
2037It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2038If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2039in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2040
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002041mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002042 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2043 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2044
2045mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2046 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2047
2048 Example:
2049 mailers mymailers
2050 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2051 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2052
2053 backend mybackend
2054 mode tcp
2055 balance roundrobin
2056
2057 email-alert mailers mymailers
2058 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2059 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2060
2061 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2062 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2063
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002064timeout mail <time>
2065 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2066 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2067 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2068 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2069
2070 Example:
2071 mailers mymailers
2072 timeout mail 20s
2073 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020754. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002076----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002078Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002079 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002080 - frontend <name>
2081 - backend <name>
2082 - listen <name>
2083
2084A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2085its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2086section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002088
2089A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2090connections.
2091
2092A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2093to forward incoming connections.
2094
2095A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2096parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2099'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2100case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2101
2102Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2103logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2104proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2105However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2106name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2107
2108Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2109and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002110bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2112modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2113arbitrary criteria.
2114
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002115In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2116a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002117the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002118
2119 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2120 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2121 between responses and new requests.
2122
2123 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2124 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2125 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002126 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2127 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002128
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002129 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2130 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2131 client-facing connection remains open.
2132
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002133 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2134 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002135
2136The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2137frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2138following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002139weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002140
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002141 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002142
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002143 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2144 ----+-----+-----+----
2145 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2146 ----+-----+-----+----
2147 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2148 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2149 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2150 ----+-----+-----+----
2151 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2156--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002158The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2159limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2160they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2161limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002162marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002163option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002164and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2165with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2166specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002168
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002169 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2170------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2171acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002172appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002173backlog X X X -
2174balance X - X X
2175bind - X X -
2176bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002177block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002178capture cookie - X X -
2179capture request header - X X -
2180capture response header - X X -
2181clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002182compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2184cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002185declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002186default-server X - X X
2187default_backend X X X -
2188description - X X X
2189disabled X X X X
2190dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002191email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002192email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002193email-alert mailers X X X X
2194email-alert myhostname X X X X
2195email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196enabled X X X X
2197errorfile X X X X
2198errorloc X X X X
2199errorloc302 X X X X
2200-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2201errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002202force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002203filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002204fullconn X - X X
2205grace X X X X
2206hash-type X - X X
2207http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002208http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002209http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002210http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002211http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002212http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002213http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002215ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002216load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002217log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002218log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002219log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002220log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002221max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222maxconn X X X -
2223mode X X X X
2224monitor fail - X X -
2225monitor-net X X X -
2226monitor-uri X X X -
2227option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2228option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2229option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2230option allbackups (*) X - X X
2231option checkcache (*) X - X X
2232option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2233option contstats (*) X X X -
2234option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2235option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002236option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002237-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2238option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002239option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002240option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002241option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002242option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002243option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002244option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002245option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002246option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002247option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002248option httpchk X - X X
2249option httpclose (*) X X X X
2250option httplog X X X X
2251option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002252option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002253option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002254option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002255option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2256option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2257option logasap (*) X X X -
2258option mysql-check X - X X
2259option nolinger (*) X X X X
2260option originalto X X X X
2261option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002262option pgsql-check X - X X
2263option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002264option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002265option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266option smtpchk X - X X
2267option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2268option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2269option splice-request (*) X X X X
2270option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002271option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002272option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2273option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2274-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002275option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002276option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2277option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2278option tcpka X X X X
2279option tcplog X X X X
2280option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002281external-check command X - X X
2282external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002283persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2284rate-limit sessions X X X -
2285redirect - X X X
2286redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2287redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2288reqadd - X X X
2289reqallow - X X X
2290reqdel - X X X
2291reqdeny - X X X
2292reqiallow - X X X
2293reqidel - X X X
2294reqideny - X X X
2295reqipass - X X X
2296reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002297reqitarpit - X X X
2298reqpass - X X X
2299reqrep - X X X
2300-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002301reqtarpit - X X X
2302retries X - X X
2303rspadd - X X X
2304rspdel - X X X
2305rspdeny - X X X
2306rspidel - X X X
2307rspideny - X X X
2308rspirep - X X X
2309rsprep - X X X
2310server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002311server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002312server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002313source X - X X
2314srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002315stats admin - X X X
2316stats auth X X X X
2317stats enable X X X X
2318stats hide-version X X X X
2319stats http-request - X X X
2320stats realm X X X X
2321stats refresh X X X X
2322stats scope X X X X
2323stats show-desc X X X X
2324stats show-legends X X X X
2325stats show-node X X X X
2326stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002327-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2328stick match - - X X
2329stick on - - X X
2330stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002331stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002332stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002333tcp-check connect - - X X
2334tcp-check expect - - X X
2335tcp-check send - - X X
2336tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002337tcp-request connection - X X -
2338tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002339tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002340tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002341tcp-response content - - X X
2342tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002343timeout check X - X X
2344timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002345timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002346timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2347timeout connect X - X X
2348timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2349timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2350timeout http-request X X X X
2351timeout queue X - X X
2352timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002353timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002354timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2355timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002356timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002357transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002358unique-id-format X X X -
2359unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002360use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002361use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002362------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2363 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023664.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2367---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368
2369This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2370
2371
2372acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2373 Declare or complete an access list.
2374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2375 no | yes | yes | yes
2376 Example:
2377 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2378 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2379 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
2383
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002384appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2385 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2388 no | no | yes | yes
2389 Arguments :
2390 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2391 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2392
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002393 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394 checked in each cookie value.
2395
2396 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2397 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2398 milliseconds.
2399
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002400 request-learn
2401 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2402 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2403 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2404 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2405 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2406 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2407
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002408 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2409 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2410 data following this prefix.
2411
2412 Example :
2413 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2414
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002415 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2416 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002417
2418 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2419 2 modes are currently supported :
2420 - path-parameters :
2421 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2422 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2423 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2424 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2425 - query-string :
2426 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2427 query string.
2428
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002429 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2430 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2431 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002433 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2434 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435
2436
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002437backlog <conns>
2438 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 yes | yes | yes | no
2441 Arguments :
2442 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2443 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002444 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002445
2446 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2447 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2448 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2449 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2450 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2451 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2452 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2453 backlog parameter.
2454
2455 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2456 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2457 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2458
2459 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2460
2461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002463balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2466 yes | no | yes | yes
2467 Arguments :
2468 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2469 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2470 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2471 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2472
2473 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2474 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2475 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2476 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002477 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002478 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002479 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2480 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2481 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2482 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2483 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2484 it, so that you don't worry.
2485
2486 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2487 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2488 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2489 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2490 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2491 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2492 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2493 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002495 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2496 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2497 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2498 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2499 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2500 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2501 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2502 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2503
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002504 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002505 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002506 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2507 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002508 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002509 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2510 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2511 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2512 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2513 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002514 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2515 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2516 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2517 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2518 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2519 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2522 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2523 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2524 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2525 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2526 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2527 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2528 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002529 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002530 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002531 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2532 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2533 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002535 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2536 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2537 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2538 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2539 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2540 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2541 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2542 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2543 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2544 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2545 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2546 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002548 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002549 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2550 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2551 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2552 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2553 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2554 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2555 URIs start with a leading "/".
2556
2557 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2558 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2559 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2560 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002563 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2564
2565 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002566 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2567 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002568 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2569 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2570 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2571 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002572 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002573 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2574 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002575
2576 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2577 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2578 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2579 server will receive the request.
2580
2581 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2582 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2583 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2584 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2585 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002586 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2587 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2588 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002590 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2591 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2592 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2593 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2594 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002596 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002597 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2598 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2599 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2600
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2603 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2604
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002605 random
2606 random(<draws>)
2607 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002608 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2609 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2610 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2611 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002612 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2613 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2614 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2615 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2616 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2617 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2618 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2619 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2620 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2621 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2622 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2623 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2624 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2625 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2626 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2627 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2628 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2629 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2630 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2631 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002632
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002633 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002634 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002635 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2636 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2637 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2638 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2639 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2640 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002641 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002642 used instead.
2643
2644 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2645 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2646 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2647 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2648
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002649 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2650 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2651 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2652
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002653 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002654
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002656 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2657 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002658
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002659 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2660 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2661 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002663 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2664 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2665 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2666 NTLM relies on.
2667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668 Examples :
2669 balance roundrobin
2670 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002671 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002672 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2673 balance hdr(host)
2674 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002675
2676 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2677 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002679 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002680 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2681 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2682 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2683 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2684
2685 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2686 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2687 defaults to 16 kB.
2688
2689 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2690 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2691
2692 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2693 Round Robin.
2694
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002695 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002696 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2697 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2698 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2699
2700 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2701
2702 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002703 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002704 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2705 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2706 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002708 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
2710
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002711bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2712bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2715 no | yes | yes | no
2716 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002717 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2718 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2719 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2720 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002721 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002722 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2723 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2724 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2725 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2726 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2727 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2728 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002729 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2730 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2731 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2732 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2733 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2734 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2735 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002736 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2737 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2738 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002739 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2740 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2741 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2742 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002743 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2744 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2745 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002746
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002747 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2748 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002749 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2750 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2751 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002752 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2753 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2754 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2755 the range.
2756
2757 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2758 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2759 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2760 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2761 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2762 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2763 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002764 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002765 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002767 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002768 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002769 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2770 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2771 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2772 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2773 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2774 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002776 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2777 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2778 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2779 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2782 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2783 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2784 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2785 in a frontend.
2786
2787 Example :
2788 listen http_proxy
2789 bind :80,:443
2790 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002791 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002793 listen http_https_proxy
2794 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002795 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002796
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002797 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2798 bind ipv6@:80
2799 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2800 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2801
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002802 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002803 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002804
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002805 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2806 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2807 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2808 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2809 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2810
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002811 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002812 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002815bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002816 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | yes
2819 Arguments :
2820 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2821 may be used to override a default value.
2822
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002823 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002824 option may be combined with other numbers.
2825
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002826 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002827 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2828 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2829 missing from all processes.
2830
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002831 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002832 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002833 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2834 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2835 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2836 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2837 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002838 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002839
2840 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2841 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2842 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2843 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2844 and 'even' instances.
2845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002846 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2847 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2848 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2849 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002850
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002851 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2852 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2853
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002854 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2855 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2856 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2857
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002858 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2859 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2860
2861 Example :
2862 listen app_ip1
2863 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002864 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002865
2866 listen app_ip2
2867 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002868 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002869
2870 listen management
2871 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002872 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002873
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002874 listen management
2875 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2876 bind-process 1-4
2877
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002878 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002879
2880
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002881block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2884 no | yes | yes | yes
2885
2886 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2887 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002888 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002889 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002890 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002891 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2892 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2893 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002894
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002895 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2896 "http-request deny" instead.
2897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898 Example:
2899 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2900 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2901 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002902 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2903 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2904 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002905
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002906 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2907 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2908 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909
2910capture cookie <name> len <length>
2911 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2913 no | yes | yes | no
2914 Arguments :
2915 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2916 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2917 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2918 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002919 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
2921 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2922 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2923 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2924 right if it exceeds <length>.
2925
2926 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2927 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2928 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2929 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2930
2931 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2932 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2933 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2934
2935 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2936 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2937 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002938 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2939 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2940 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002941
2942 Example:
2943 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2944
2945 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002946 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947
2948
2949capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002950 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2952 no | yes | yes | no
2953 Arguments :
2954 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002955 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2957 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2958 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2959
2960 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2961 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2962 it exceeds <length>.
2963
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002964 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2966 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002967 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2968 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2969 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2970 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002971 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002972 environments to find where the request came from.
2973
2974 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2975 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2976 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2977 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002979 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2980 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2981 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2982 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2983 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984
2985 Example:
2986 capture request header Host len 15
2987 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002988 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002990 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002991 about logging.
2992
2993
2994capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002995 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 no | yes | yes | no
2998 Arguments :
2999 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003000 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003001 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3002 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3003 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3004
3005 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3006 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3007 it exceeds <length>.
3008
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003009 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3011 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3012 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003013 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3014 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3015 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3016 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003017
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003018 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3019 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3020 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3021 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3022 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
3024 Example:
3025 capture response header Content-length len 9
3026 capture response header Location len 15
3027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003028 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029 about logging.
3030
3031
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003032clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | no
3036 Arguments :
3037 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3038 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3039 as explained at the top of this document.
3040
3041 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3042 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3043 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3044 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3045 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3046 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3047 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3048 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003049 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003050 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003051 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052
3053 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3054 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3055 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3056 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3057 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3058 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3059
3060 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3061 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3062
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003063 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3064 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003066compression algo <algorithm> ...
3067compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003068compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003069 Enable HTTP compression.
3070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 yes | yes | yes | yes
3072 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003073 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3074 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3075 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3076
3077 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003078 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3079 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3080 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003081
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003082 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003083 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003084
3085 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3086 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3087 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3088 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3089 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003090 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003091
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003092 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3093 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3094 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3095 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3096 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3097 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3098 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003099 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003100
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003101 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003102 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003103 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3104 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3105 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3106 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3107 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003108
3109 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3110 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3111 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3112 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3113 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003114 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3115 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3116 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3117 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3118 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003119 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3120 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003121
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003122 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003123 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3124 "Accept-Encoding" header
3125 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003126 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003127 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3128 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3129 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3130 "multipart"
3131 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3132 header
3133 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3134 and later
3135 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3136 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003137 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003138
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003139 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003140
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003141 Examples :
3142 compression algo gzip
3143 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003145
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003146contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003147 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3149 yes | no | yes | yes
3150 Arguments :
3151 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3153 as explained at the top of this document.
3154
3155 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003156 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003157 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003158 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3160 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3161 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3162
3163 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3164 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3165 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3166 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3167 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3168 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3169
3170 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3171 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3172 instead.
3173
3174 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3175 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3176
3177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003178cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003179 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3180 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003181 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 yes | no | yes | yes
3185 Arguments :
3186 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3187 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3188 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3189 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3190 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3191 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003192 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3194 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3195
3196 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3197 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3198 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3199 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3200 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3201 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003202 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3203 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003204 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003205 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3206 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003207
3208 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003209 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003210
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003211 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003212 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3213 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003215 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3216 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3217 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3218 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3219 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3220 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3221 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222
3223 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3224 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3225 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3226 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3227 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3228 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3229 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3230 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3231 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003232 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003233 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3234 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3235 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003236
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003237 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3238 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3239 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003240 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3241 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3242 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3243 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003244 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3245 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3246 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247
3248 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3249 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3250 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3251 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3252 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3253 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3254 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3255 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3256 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3257
3258 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3259 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3260 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3261 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3262 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3263 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3264 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3265 persistence cookie in the cache.
3266 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3267
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3269 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3270 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3271 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3272 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003273 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003274 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3275 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3276 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3277 they logout.
3278
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003279 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3280 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3281 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3282 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3283
3284 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3285 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3286 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3287 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3288 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3289 this attribute.
3290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003291 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003292 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003293 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3294 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3295 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3296 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3297 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3298 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003299
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003300 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3301 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3302 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3303 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3304 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3305 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3306 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3307 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003308 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003309 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3310 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3311 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3312 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3313 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3314 the site.
3315
3316 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3317 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3318 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3319 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3320 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3321 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3322 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3323 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3324 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3325 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3326 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3327 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3328 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003330 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3331 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3332
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003333 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3334 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3335 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3336 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3337 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3338 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3341 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3342 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3343 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 Examples :
3346 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3347 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3348 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003349 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003351 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003352
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003353
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003354declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3355 Declares a capture slot.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 no | yes | yes | no
3358 Arguments:
3359 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3360
3361 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3362 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3363 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3364 for use in the response.
3365
3366 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003367 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003368 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3369
3370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003371default-server [param*]
3372 Change default options for a server in a backend
3373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 yes | no | yes | yes
3375 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003376 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3377 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3378 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3379 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003380
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003381 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003382 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3383
3384 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003387default_backend <backend>
3388 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | yes | yes | no
3391 Arguments :
3392 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3393
3394 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3395 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3396 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3397 will catch all undetermined requests.
3398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003399 Example :
3400
3401 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3402 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3403 default_backend dynamic
3404
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003405 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003408description <string>
3409 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3411 no | yes | yes | yes
3412 Arguments : string
3413
3414 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3415 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3416 it describes.
3417 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3418
3419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420disabled
3421 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 yes | yes | yes | yes
3424 Arguments : none
3425
3426 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3427 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3428 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3429 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3430 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3431 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3432 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3433
3434 See also : "enabled"
3435
3436
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003437dispatch <address>:<port>
3438 Set a default server address
3439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3440 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003442
3443 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3444 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3445 during start-up.
3446
3447 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3448 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3449 possible with normal servers.
3450
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003451 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003452 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3453 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3454 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3455 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3456
3457 See also : "server"
3458
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003459
3460dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3461 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | no | yes | yes
3464 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3465
3466 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003467 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003468 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3469 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003471 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003472
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473enabled
3474 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | yes
3477 Arguments : none
3478
3479 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3480 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3481
3482 See also : "disabled"
3483
3484
3485errorfile <code> <file>
3486 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 yes | yes | yes | yes
3489 Arguments :
3490 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003491 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3492 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493
3494 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003495 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003496 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003497 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3498 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499
3500 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3501 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3502 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3503
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003504 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3507 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3508 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3509 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3510
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003511 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3512 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003513 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003514 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3515 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3516 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3519 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3520 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003521 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3523
3524 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003526 Example :
3527 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003528 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003529 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3530 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003532
3533errorloc <code> <url>
3534errorloc302 <code> <url>
3535 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 yes | yes | yes | yes
3538 Arguments :
3539 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003540 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3541 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003542
3543 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3544 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3545 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3546 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003547 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548
3549 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3550 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3551 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3552
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003553 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3554
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003555 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3556 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3557 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3558 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003559 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3561 request.
3562
3563 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3564
3565
3566errorloc303 <code> <url>
3567 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | yes | yes | yes
3570 Arguments :
3571 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003572 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3573 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003574
3575 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3576 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3577 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3578 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003579 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003580
3581 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3582 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3583 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3584
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003585 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3588 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3589 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3590 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003591 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003592
3593 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3594
3595
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003596email-alert from <emailaddr>
3597 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003598 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601
3602 Arguments :
3603
3604 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3605
3606 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3607 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3608
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003609 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003610 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3611 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003612
3613
3614email-alert level <level>
3615 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3616 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | yes | yes | yes
3619
3620 Arguments :
3621
3622 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3623 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3624 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3625
3626 By default level is alert
3627
3628 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3629 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3630 for the proxy.
3631
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003632 Alerts are sent when :
3633
3634 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3635 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3636 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3637 is notice or lower
3638 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3639 and a health check status update occurs
3640
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003641 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3642 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003643 section 3.6 about mailers.
3644
3645
3646email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3647 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | yes
3650
3651 Arguments :
3652
3653 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3654
3655 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3656 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3657
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003658 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3659 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003660
3661
3662email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3663 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3664 mailers.
3665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667
3668 Arguments :
3669
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003670 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003671
3672 By default the systems hostname is used.
3673
3674 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3675 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3676 for the proxy.
3677
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003678 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3679 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003680
3681
3682email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003683 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003684 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3686 yes | yes | yes | yes
3687
3688 Arguments :
3689
3690 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3691
3692 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3693 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3694
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003695 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003696 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3697
3698
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003699force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3700 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003702 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003703
3704 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3705 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3706 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3707 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3708 marked down for maintenance operations.
3709
3710 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3711 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3712 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3713 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3714 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3715 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3716 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3717 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3718 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3719
3720 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3721 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3722 is used.
3723
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003724 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003725 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003726
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003727
3728filter <name> [param*]
3729 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 no | yes | yes | yes
3732 Arguments :
3733 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3734 referenced in section 9.
3735
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003736 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003737 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003738 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3739 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003740
3741 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3742 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3743
3744 Example:
3745 listen
3746 bind *:80
3747
3748 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3749 filter compression
3750 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3751
3752 compression algo gzip
3753 compression offload
3754
3755 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3756
3757 See also : section 9.
3758
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003760fullconn <conns>
3761 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | no | yes | yes
3764 Arguments :
3765 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3766 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3767
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003768 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003770 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003771 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3772 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3773 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3774 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3775 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003776 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003777
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003778 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3779 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003780 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3781 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3782 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003783
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003784 Example :
3785 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3786 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3787 # connections.
3788 backend dynamic
3789 fullconn 10000
3790 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3791 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3792
3793 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3794
3795
3796grace <time>
3797 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003799 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003800 Arguments :
3801 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3802 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3803 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3804
3805 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3806 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003807 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003808 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3809
3810 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3811 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3812 simplify it.
3813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003814
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003815hash-balance-factor <factor>
3816 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3818 yes | no | no | yes
3819 Arguments :
3820 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3821 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3822 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3823
3824 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3825 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3826 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3827 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3828 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3829 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3830 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3831
3832 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3833 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3834 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3835 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3836 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3837
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003838 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3839 consistent hashing mechanism.
3840
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003841 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3842
3843
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003844hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003845 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 yes | no | yes | yes
3848 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003849 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3850 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003851
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003852 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3853 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3854 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3855 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3856 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3857 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3858 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3859 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3860 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3861 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003862
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003863 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3864 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3865 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3866 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3867 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3868 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3869 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3870 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3871 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3872 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3873 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3874 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3875 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003876 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3877 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003878
3879 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3880
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003881 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003882 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3883 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3884 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003885 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3886 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3887 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003888
3889 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3890 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003891 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3892 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3893 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3894 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3895
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003896 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3897 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3898 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3899 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3900 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3901 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3902 parameter.
3903
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003904 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3905 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3906 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3907 used on strings.
3908
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003909 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3910
3911 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3912 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3913 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3914 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3915 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3916 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3917 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3918 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3919 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3920 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3921 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3922 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003923
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003924 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3925 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3926 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003927
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003928 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003929
3930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931http-check disable-on-404
3932 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003934 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935 Arguments : none
3936
3937 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3938 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3939 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3940 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3941 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3942 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3943 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3944 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003945 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3946 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3947 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3948
3949 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3950
3951
3952http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003953 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003956 Arguments :
3957 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3958 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003959 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003960 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3961 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3962 details on the supported keywords.
3963
3964 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3965 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3966 with the usual backslash ('\').
3967
3968 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3969 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3970 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3971 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3972 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3973
3974 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003975 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003976 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3977 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3978 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3979
3980 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003981 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003982 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3983 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3984 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3985 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3986
3987 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003988 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003989 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3990 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3991 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3992 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3993 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003994 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003995 trace).
3996
3997 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003998 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003999 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4000 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4001 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4002 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4003 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004004 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004005
4006 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4007 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4008 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4009 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4010 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4011 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4012 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4013 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4014
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004015 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4016 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4017 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4018
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004019 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4020 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4021
4022 Examples :
4023 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004024 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004025
4026 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004027 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004028
4029 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004030 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004031
4032 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004033 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004035 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036
4037
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004038http-check send-state
4039 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 yes | no | yes | yes
4042 Arguments : none
4043
4044 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4045 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4046 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4047 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4048 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4049
4050 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4051 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4052 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4053 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4054 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004055 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4056 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4057 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4058
4059 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4060 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4061 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4062
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004063 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4064 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4065 checked in multiple backends.
4066
4067 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4068 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4069
4070 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4071 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4072 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4073 one fails.
4074
4075 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4076 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4077 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4078
4079 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4080 server's queue.
4081
4082 Example of a header received by the application server :
4083 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4084 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4085
4086 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004088
4089http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004090 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4091
4092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 no | yes | yes | yes
4094
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004095 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4096 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4097 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4098 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4099 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004101 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4102 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004104 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004106 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4107 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4108 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4109 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004111 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4112 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4113 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4114 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004116 Example:
4117 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4118 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4119 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004121 http-request allow if nagios
4122 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4123 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4124 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004126 Example:
4127 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4128 acl add path /addacl
4129 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004131 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004133 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4134 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004136 Example:
4137 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4138 acl setmap path /setmap
4139 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004141 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4144 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004146 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4147 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4152 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4153 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4154 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4155 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4156 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4157 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4158 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4163 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4164 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4165 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4166 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4167 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4168 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4169 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004171http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4174 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004175
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4180 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4181 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4182 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4183 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 Example:
4186 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4187 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004189http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004193http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4197 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4198 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4199 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4200 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4201 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4202 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4203 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4204 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4207 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4208 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4209 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4210 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4211 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4216 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4217 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4218 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4219 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4220 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4229 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4230 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4231 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4232 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4233 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4238 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4239 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4240 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4241 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004242
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004243http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4244
4245 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4246 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4247 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4248 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004249 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4250 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004251
4252 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4257 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4258 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4259 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4260 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4265 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4266 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4267 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4273 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4274 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4275 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4276 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4277 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4278 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4279 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 Example:
4282 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 # applied to:
4285 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287 # outputs:
4288 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4296 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4297 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4298 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 Example:
4301 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 # applied to:
4304 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 # outputs:
4307 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4310http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4313 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4314 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4319 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4320 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4325 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4326 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4327 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4328 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Arguments:
4331 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4332 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 Example:
4335 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4336 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4339 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4344 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4345 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 Arguments:
4348 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4349 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 Example:
4352 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4353 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4356 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4357 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4362 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4363 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4364 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4365 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 Example:
4368 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4369 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4370 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4371 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4372 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4373 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4374 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4375 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4376 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4381 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4382 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4383 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4384 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4390 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4391 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4392 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4393 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4394 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4395 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4396 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4397 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004401 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4402 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4403 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4404 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4405 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4406 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4407 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4412 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4413 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4418 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4419 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4420 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4421 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4422 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4423 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4424 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4429 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4430 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4431 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4432 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4433 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 Example :
4436 # prepend the host name before the path
4437 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004441 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4442 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4443 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4444 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4445 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004449 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4450 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4451 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4452 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4453 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4454 values have higher priority.
4455 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4456 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4457 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4458 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4459 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004463 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4464 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4465 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4466 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4467 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4468 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4469 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004472
4473 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4475 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004477http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4478 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4479 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4480 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4481 privacy.
4482
4483 Arguments :
4484 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4485 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004486
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004487 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4489 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4490
4491 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4492 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4493
4494http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4495
4496 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4497 expression.
4498
4499 Arguments:
4500 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4501 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004502
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004503 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4505 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4506
4507 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4508 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4509 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4510
4511http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4512
4513 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4514 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4515 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4516 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4517 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4518 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4519 information from the request.
4520
4521 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4522
4523http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4524
4525 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4526 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4527 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4528 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4529 path and the query string.
4530 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4531
4532http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4533
4534 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4535 inline.
4536
4537 Arguments:
4538 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4539 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4540 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4541 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4542 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4543 (request and response)
4544 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4545 processing
4546 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4547 processing
4548 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4549 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4550 and '_'.
4551
4552 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4553 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004554
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004555 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4559 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4562 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4563 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4564 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4565 agent name must be used.
4566
4567 Arguments:
4568 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4569
4570 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4571 configuration.
4572
4573http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4574
4575 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4576 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4577 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4578 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4579 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4580 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4581 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4582 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4583 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4584 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4585 action.
4586 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4587 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4588 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4589 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4590 you fully understand how it works.
4591
4592http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593
4594 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4595 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4596 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4597 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4598 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4599 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4600 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4601 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4602 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4603 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4604 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4605 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4606 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4607
4608http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4609http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4610http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4611
4612 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4613 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4614 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4615 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4616 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4617 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4618 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4619 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4620 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4621 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4622 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4623 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4624
4625 Arguments :
4626 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4627 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4628 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4629 select which table entry to update the counters.
4630
4631 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4632 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4633 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4634 that table until the session ends.
4635
4636 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4637 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4638 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4639 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4640 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4641 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4642 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4643 useful information.
4644
4645 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4646 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4647 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4648 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4649 checks that make use of it.
4650
4651http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4652
4653 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004654
4655 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4661 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4662 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004663
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004665http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004666 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4667
4668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 no | yes | yes | yes
4670
4671 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4672 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4673 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4674 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4675 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4676 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004678 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4679 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4684 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4685 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4686 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004688 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4689 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4690 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4691 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004693 Example:
4694 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004698 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4699 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 Example:
4702 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004703
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004704 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4707 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004709 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4710 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004714 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4715 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4716 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4717 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4718 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4719 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4720 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4721 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004725 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4726 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4727 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4728 example, or to pass some internal information.
4729 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4730 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4731 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004733http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004735 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4736 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004737
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004738http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004742http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004744 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4745 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4746 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4747 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4748 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4749 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4750 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4753 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4754 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4755 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4756 keyword.
4757 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4758 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4763 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4764 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4765 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4766 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4767 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004769http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004771 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004773http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4776 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4777 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4778 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4779 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4780 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004782http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004784 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4785 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4790 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4791 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4792 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4793 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4794 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004799 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4800 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4801 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4802 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4803 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4804 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4805 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4806 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 Example:
4809 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 # applied to:
4812 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814 # outputs:
4815 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4823 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4824 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4825 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 Example:
4828 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830 # applied to:
4831 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004833 # outputs:
4834 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4837http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4840 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4841 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4846 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4847 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4852 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4853 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4854 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4855 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 Arguments:
4858 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4861 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4866 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4867 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4870
4871 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4872 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4873 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4874 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4875 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4876
4877http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4878
4879 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4880 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4881 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4882 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4883 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4884 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4885 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4886 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4887 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4888
4889http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4890
4891 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4892 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4893 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4894 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4895 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4896 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4897 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4898
4899http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4900
4901 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4902 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4903 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4904 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4905 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4906 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4907 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4908 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4909
4910http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4911 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4912
4913 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4914 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4915 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4916 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004917
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004918 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4920 http-response set-status 431
4921 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4922 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004924http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4927 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4928 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4929 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4930 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4931 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4932 based on some information from the request.
4933
4934 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4935
4936http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4937
4938 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4939 inline.
4940
4941 Arguments:
4942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4943 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4944 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4945 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4946 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4947 (request and response)
4948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4949 processing
4950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4951 processing
4952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4953 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4954 and '_'.
4955
4956 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4957 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004958
4959 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4965 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4966 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4967 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4968 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4969 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4970 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4971 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4972 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4973 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4974 action.
4975 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4976 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4977 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4978 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4979 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4982http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4983http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4986 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4987 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4988 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4989 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4990 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4991
4992http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4995 about <var-name>.
4996
4997 Example:
4998 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4999
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005000
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005001http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5002 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5003
5004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 yes | no | yes | yes
5006
5007 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005008 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5009 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5010 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005011
5012 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5013
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005014 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5015 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5016 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5017 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5018 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5019 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5020 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5021 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5022 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5023 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005024
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005025 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5026 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5027 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5028 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5029 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5030 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5031 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5032 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005033
5034 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5035 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5036 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5037 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5038 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5039 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5040 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5041 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5042 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5043 downsides of rare connection failures.
5044
5045 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5046 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5047 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5048 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5049 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5050 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005051 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005052 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5053 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5054 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5055 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5056 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5057
5058 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005059 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5060 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5061 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005062
5063 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005064 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005065
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005066 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5067 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005068
5069 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5070 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5071 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5072
5073 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5074 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5075 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5076
5077 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5078
5079
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005080http-send-name-header [<header>]
5081 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5082
5083 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5084 yes | no | yes | yes
5085
5086 Arguments :
5087
5088 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5089
5090 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005091 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005092 is added with the header string proved.
5093
5094 See also : "server"
5095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005096id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005097 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 no | yes | yes | yes
5100 Arguments : none
5101
5102 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5103 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5104 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005105
5106
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005107ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5108 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005110 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005111
5112 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5113 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5114 and running).
5115
5116 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5117 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5118 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005119 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005120 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5121
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005122 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5123 "unless" condition is met.
5124
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005125 Example:
5126 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5127 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5128 ignore-persist if url_static
5129
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005130 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5131
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005132load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5133 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136
5137 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5138 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5139 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005140 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005141 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5142 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5143 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5144 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005146 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005147 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005148 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005149
5150 Arguments:
5151 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5152 named "server-state-file".
5153
5154 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5155 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5156 name is used as a file name.
5157
5158 none don't load any stat for this backend
5159
5160 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005161 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5162 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5163 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005164 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005165 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005166
5167 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5168 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5169
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005170 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005171
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005172 global
5173 stats socket /tmp/socket
5174 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005175
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005176 defaults
5177 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005178
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005179 backend bk
5180 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5181 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005182
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005183
5184 Then one can run :
5185
5186 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5187
5188 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5189
5190 1
5191 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5192 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5193 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005195 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005196
5197 global
5198 stats socket /tmp/socket
5199 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5200
5201 defaults
5202 load-server-state-from-file local
5203
5204 backend bk
5205 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5206 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5207
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005208
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005209 Then one can run :
5210
5211 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5212
5213 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5214
5215 1
5216 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5217 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5218 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5219
5220 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5221 "show servers state"
5222
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005224log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005225log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005226no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005227 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005230
5231 Prefix :
5232 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5233 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5234 prefix does not allow arguments.
5235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005236 Arguments :
5237 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5238 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5239 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5240 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5241 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5242 parameter.
5243
5244 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5245 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5246
5247 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5248 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5249 standard syslog port).
5250
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005251 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5252 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5253 standard syslog port).
5254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005255 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5256 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5257 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005258 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005259
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005260 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5261 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5262 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5263 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5264 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5265 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5266 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5267 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5268 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5269 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5270 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5271 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5272 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5273 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5274 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5275 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005276 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5277 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005278
5279 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5280 and "fd@2", see above.
5281
5282 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5283 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005284
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005285 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5286 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5287 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5288 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5289 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5290 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5291 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5292 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5293 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5294 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005295 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005296
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005297 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5298 one of the following :
5299
5300 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5301 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5302
5303 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5304 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5305
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005306 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5307 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5308 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5309 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5310 systemd logger consumes.
5311
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005312 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5313 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5314 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5315 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5316
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005317 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5318
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005319 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5320 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5321 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5322
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005323 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5324 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5325 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5326 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005327
5328 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5329 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5330 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005331 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5332 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5333 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5334 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5335 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336
5337 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5338
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005339 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5340 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5341 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005342
5343 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5344 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5345 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5346 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5347
5348 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5349 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005350
5351 Example :
5352 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005353 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5354 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5355 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005356 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5357 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005358 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005360
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005361log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005362 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005365
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005366 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5367 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5368 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5369 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5370 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005371
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005372 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5373 "option httplog" directives.
5374
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005375log-format-sd <string>
5376 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | yes | yes | no
5379
5380 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5381 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5382 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5383 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5384 which covers the log format string in depth.
5385
5386 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5387 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5388
5389 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5390 log format to "rfc5424".
5391
5392 Example :
5393 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5394
5395
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005396log-tag <string>
5397 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5399 yes | yes | yes | yes
5400
5401 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5402 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5403 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5404 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5405 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5406 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5407 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5408 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5409 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005410
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005411max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5412 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5414 yes | no | yes | yes
5415
5416 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5417 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5418 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5419 servers.
5420
5421 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5422 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5423 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5424 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5425 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005426 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005427 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5428 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5429 picking a different server.
5430
5431 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5432 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5433 even if they have to be queued.
5434
5435 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5436 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5437
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005438max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5439 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5440 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5441 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005443maxconn <conns>
5444 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | yes | yes | no
5447 Arguments :
5448 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5449 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5450 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5451 closes.
5452
5453 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5454 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5455 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5456 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005457 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5458 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5459 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5460 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461
5462 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5463 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5464 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5465
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005466 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005468 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5469
5470
5471mode { tcp|http|health }
5472 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5474 yes | yes | yes | yes
5475 Arguments :
5476 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5477 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5478 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5479 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5480
5481 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5482 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5483 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5484 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5485 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5486
5487 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005488 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5489 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5490 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5491 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5492 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5493 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5494 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005495
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005496 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5497 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5498 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005499
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005500 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005501 defaults http_instances
5502 mode http
5503
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005504 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005506
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005507monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005508 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005511 Arguments :
5512 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5513 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005514 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005515 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5516 backend and its backup.
5517
5518 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5519 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5520 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5521 servers in a list of backends.
5522
5523 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5524 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5525 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5526 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5527 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5528 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5529 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005530 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5531 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005532
5533 Example:
5534 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005536 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5537 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5538 monitor-uri /site_alive
5539 monitor fail if site_dead
5540
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005541 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005542
5543
5544monitor-net <source>
5545 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5547 yes | yes | yes | no
5548 Arguments :
5549 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5550 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5551 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5552 followed by a mask.
5553
5554 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5555 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005556 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005557 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5558
5559 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5560 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5561 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5562 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005563 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5564 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5565 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005566
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005567 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5568 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5569 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5570 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5571 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5572 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005573
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005574 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5575 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005577 Example :
5578 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5579 frontend www
5580 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5581
5582 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5583
5584
5585monitor-uri <uri>
5586 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | yes | yes | no
5589 Arguments :
5590 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5591 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5592
5593 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5594 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5595 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5596 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5597 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5598 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5599 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5600 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5601
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005602 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5603 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5604 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5605 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5606 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5607 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5608 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5609 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005610
5611 Example :
5612 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5613 frontend www
5614 mode http
5615 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5616
5617 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005619
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005620option abortonclose
5621no option abortonclose
5622 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625 Arguments : none
5626
5627 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5628 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5629 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5630 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005631 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005632 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5633 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5634 encountered while delivering the response.
5635
5636 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5637 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5638 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5639 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5640 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5641 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005642 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005643 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005644 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005645 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5646 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5647 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5648
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005649 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5650 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005651 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5652 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5653 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5654 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5655 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5656 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005657 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005658
5659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5661
5662 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5663
5664
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005665option accept-invalid-http-request
5666no option accept-invalid-http-request
5667 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5669 yes | yes | yes | no
5670 Arguments : none
5671
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005672 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005673 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005674 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005675 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5676 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5677 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5678 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5679 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005680 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5681 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5682 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5683 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005684 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005685 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005686 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5687 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5688 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005689
5690 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5691 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5692 been confirmed.
5693
5694 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5695 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005696 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5697 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005698 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5699
5700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5702
5703 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5704 stats socket.
5705
5706
5707option accept-invalid-http-response
5708no option accept-invalid-http-response
5709 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5711 yes | no | yes | yes
5712 Arguments : none
5713
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005714 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005715 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005716 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005717 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5718 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5719 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5720 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5721 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005722 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5723 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5724 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005725
5726 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5727 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5728 been confirmed.
5729
5730 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5731 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5732 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5733 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5734
5735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5737
5738 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5739 stats socket.
5740
5741
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005742option allbackups
5743no option allbackups
5744 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 yes | no | yes | yes
5747 Arguments : none
5748
5749 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5750 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5751 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5752 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5753 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5754 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5755 order between the backup servers anymore.
5756
5757 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5758 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5759
5760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5762
5763
5764option checkcache
5765no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005766 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | no | yes | yes
5769 Arguments : none
5770
5771 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5772 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005773 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005774 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5775 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005776 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005777
5778 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005779 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005780 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005781 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5782 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005783 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005784 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005785 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5786 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005788 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5789 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005790 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005791 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5792 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5793 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5794 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5795 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5796 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5797 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5798 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5799 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5800
5801 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005802 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005803 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005804 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005805 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5806
5807 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5808 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005809 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005810 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005811
5812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5814
5815
5816option clitcpka
5817no option clitcpka
5818 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | yes | yes | no
5821 Arguments : none
5822
5823 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5824 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005825 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005826 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5827
5828 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5829 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5830 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5831 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5832
5833 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5834 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5835 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5836 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5837 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5838
5839 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5840
5841 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5842 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5843 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5844
5845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5847
5848 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5849
5850
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005851option contstats
5852 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5854 yes | yes | yes | no
5855 Arguments : none
5856
5857 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5858 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5859 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5860 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005861 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5862 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5863 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5864 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5865 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005866
5867
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005868option dontlog-normal
5869no option dontlog-normal
5870 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | yes | yes | no
5873 Arguments : none
5874
5875 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5876 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5877 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5878 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5879 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5880 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5881 logged.
5882
5883 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5884 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5885 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005887 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005888 logging.
5889
5890
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005891option dontlognull
5892no option dontlognull
5893 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | yes | yes | no
5896 Arguments : none
5897
5898 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5899 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5900 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5901 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5902 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5903 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005904 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5905 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5906 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005907
5908 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005909 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005910 would not be logged.
5911
5912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5914
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005915 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5916 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005917
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005918
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005919option forceclose (deprecated)
5920no option forceclose (deprecated)
5921 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005922
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005923 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005924
5925
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005926option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005927 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5929 yes | yes | yes | yes
5930 Arguments :
5931 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5932 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005933 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005934 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005935
5936 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5937 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5938 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5939 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5940 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5941 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5942 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005943 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5944 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5945 possible that the client has already brought one.
5946
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005947 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005948 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005949 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005950 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005951 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005952 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005953
5954 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5955 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5956 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5957 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5958 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5959 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5960 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5961
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005962 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5963 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5964 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5965 are under the control of the end-user.
5966
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005967 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005968 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5969 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005970 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5971 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5972 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005973
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005974 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005975 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5976 frontend www
5977 mode http
5978 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5979
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005980 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5981 backend www
5982 mode http
5983 option forwardfor header X-Client
5984
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005985 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005986 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005987
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005988
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005989option http-buffer-request
5990no option http-buffer-request
5991 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 yes | yes | yes | yes
5994 Arguments : none
5995
5996 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5997 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5998 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5999 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6000 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6001 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6002 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6003 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006004 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006005 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6006 default.
6007
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006008 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006009
6010
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006011option http-ignore-probes
6012no option http-ignore-probes
6013 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | yes | yes | no
6016 Arguments : none
6017
6018 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6019 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6020 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6021 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6022 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6023 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6024 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6025 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6026 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006027 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6028 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006029 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6030
6031 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6032 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6033 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6034 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6035 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6036 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6037 are often the only way to detect them.
6038
6039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6041
6042 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6043
6044
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006045option http-keep-alive
6046no option http-keep-alive
6047 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | yes | yes | yes
6050 Arguments : none
6051
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006052 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6053 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006054 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6055 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6056 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6057 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6058 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006059
6060 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6061 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006062 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6063 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6064 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6065 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6066 situations where this option may be useful :
6067
6068 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006069 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006070
6071 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6072 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6073
6074 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6075 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6076 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6077 request.
6078
6079 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6080 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006081 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6082 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6083 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006084
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006085 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6086 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6087 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6088 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6089 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6090 not set.
6091
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006092 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006093 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6094 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006095
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006096 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006097 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006098 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006099
6100
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006101option http-no-delay
6102no option http-no-delay
6103 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6105 yes | yes | yes | yes
6106 Arguments : none
6107
6108 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6109 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6110 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6111 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6112 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6113 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6114 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6115 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6116 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6117 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6118 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6119 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6120 affected.
6121
6122 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6123 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6124 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6125 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6126 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6127 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6128 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6129 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6130 latency environments.
6131
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006132 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6133
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006134
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006135option http-pretend-keepalive
6136no option http-pretend-keepalive
6137 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006139 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006140 Arguments : none
6141
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006142 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006143 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6144 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6145 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6146 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6147 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6148 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6149 consider the response complete.
6150
6151 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6152 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6153 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6154 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006155 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006156 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6157
6158 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6159 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6160 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6161 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6162 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6163 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6164 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6165
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006166 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6167 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6168 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6169 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6170 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6171 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006172
6173 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6174 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6175
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006176 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006177 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006178
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006179
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006180option http-server-close
6181no option http-server-close
6182 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | yes | yes | yes
6185 Arguments : none
6186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006187 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6188 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6189 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6190 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006191 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6192 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6193 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6194 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6195 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6196 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6197 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6198 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6199 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6200 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6201 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006202
6203 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6204 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6205 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6206 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006207 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6208 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006209
6210 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6211 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006212 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6213 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6214 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006219 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6220 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006221
6222
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006223option http-tunnel
6224no option http-tunnel
6225 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006227 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006228 Arguments : none
6229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006230 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6231 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6232 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6233 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006234 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006235
6236 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006237 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006238 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6239 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6240 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6241 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6242 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6243 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6244 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006245
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006246 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6247 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6248 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6249 backend.
6250
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6253
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006254 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6255 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006256
6257
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006258option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006259no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006260 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6262 yes | yes | yes | no
6263 Arguments : none
6264
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006265 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006266 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6267 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6268 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6269 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6270 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6271 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6272
6273 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6274 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006275 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6276 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6277 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006278
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006279 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6280 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6281 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6282 front of an existing proxy.
6283
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006284 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6285
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006286 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006287
6288
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006289option http-use-htx
6290no option http-use-htx
6291 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments : none
6295
6296 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6297 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6298 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6299 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6300 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6301 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6302 representation.
6303
6304 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6305 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6306 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6307 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6308 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6309 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6310 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6311 other side's version.
6312
6313 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6314 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6315 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6316 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6317 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6318
6319 See also : "mode http"
6320
6321
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006322option httpchk
6323option httpchk <uri>
6324option httpchk <method> <uri>
6325option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6326 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6328 yes | no | yes | yes
6329 Arguments :
6330 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6331 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6332 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6333 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6334 ones.
6335
6336 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6337 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6338 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6339
6340 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6341 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6342 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6343 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6344 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6345
6346 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6347 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6348 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6349 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6350 the lack of any response.
6351
6352 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6353
6354 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6355 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6356 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6357
6358 Examples :
6359 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6360 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6361 backend https_relay
6362 mode tcp
6363 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6364 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6365
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006366 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6367 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6368 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006369
6370
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006371option httpclose
6372no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006373 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 yes | yes | yes | yes
6376 Arguments : none
6377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006378 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6379 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6380 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6381 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006382 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006383
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006384 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6385 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6386 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6387 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6388 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006389
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006390 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6391 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6392 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006393
6394 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6395 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006396 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006397 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6398 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6399 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006400
6401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6403
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006404 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006405
6406
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006407option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006408 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006410 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006411 Arguments :
6412 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6413 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6414 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006415 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006416 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006417
6418 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6419 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6420 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6421 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6422 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6423 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6424 ports.
6425
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006426 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6427 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006428
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006429 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006431 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006432
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006433
6434option http_proxy
6435no option http_proxy
6436 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | yes | yes | yes
6439 Arguments : none
6440
6441 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6442 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6443 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6444 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6445 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6446
6447 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6448 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006449 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6450 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006451
6452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6454
6455 Example :
6456 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6457 backend direct_forward
6458 option httpclose
6459 option http_proxy
6460
6461 See also : "option httpclose"
6462
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006463
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006464option independent-streams
6465no option independent-streams
6466 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | yes | yes | yes
6469 Arguments : none
6470
6471 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6472 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6473 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6474 receive data or not.
6475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006476 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006477 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6478 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6479 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6480 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6481 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6482 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6483 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6484 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6485 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6486 socket buffers.
6487
6488 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6489 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6490 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6491 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6492 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6493
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006494 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006495 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6496 deprecated.
6497
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006498 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006499
6500
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006501option ldap-check
6502 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6504 yes | no | yes | yes
6505 Arguments : none
6506
6507 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6508 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6509 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6510 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6511
6512 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6513 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6514
6515 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6516 configure it.
6517
6518 Example :
6519 option ldap-check
6520
6521 See also : "option httpchk"
6522
6523
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006524option external-check
6525 Use external processes for server health checks
6526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6527 yes | no | yes | yes
6528
6529 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6530 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6531 command".
6532
6533 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6534
6535 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6536
6537
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006538option log-health-checks
6539no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006540 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6542 yes | no | yes | yes
6543 Arguments : none
6544
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006545 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6546 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6547 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006548
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006549 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6550 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6551 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6552 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6553 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006555 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006556 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006557
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006558 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6559 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6560 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006561
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006562
6563option log-separate-errors
6564no option log-separate-errors
6565 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6567 yes | yes | yes | no
6568 Arguments : none
6569
6570 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6571 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6572 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6573 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6574 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6575 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6576 provides very important information.
6577
6578 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6579 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6580 error logs.
6581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006582 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006583 logging.
6584
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006585
6586option logasap
6587no option logasap
6588 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | yes | yes | no
6591 Arguments : none
6592
6593 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6594 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6595 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6596 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6597 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6598 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6599 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006600 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006601 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6602 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006604 Examples :
6605 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6606 mode http
6607 option httplog
6608 option logasap
6609 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6610
6611 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6612 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6613 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6614 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006616 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006617 logging.
6618
6619
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006620option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006621 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006624 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006625 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6626 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006627 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006628
6629 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6630 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006631 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006632 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6633 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6634 in the MySQL table, like this :
6635
6636 USE mysql;
6637 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6638 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6639
6640 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006641 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006642 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6643 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6644 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6645 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6646 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6647 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6648 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6649
6650 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6651 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006652
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006653 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006654
6655 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6656 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6657 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6658 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006659 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6660 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006661
6662 See also: "option httpchk"
6663
6664
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006665option nolinger
6666no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006667 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006670 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006672 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006673 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6674 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6675 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6676 connections.
6677
6678 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6679 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6680 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6681 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6682 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6683 this too.
6684
6685 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6686 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6687 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6688
6689 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6690 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6691 for servers.
6692
6693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6695
6696
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006697option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6698 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 yes | yes | yes | yes
6701 Arguments :
6702 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6703 matching <network>
6704 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6705 header name.
6706
6707 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6708 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6709 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6710 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6711 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6712 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6713 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6714 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6715 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6716 possible that the client has already brought one.
6717
6718 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6719 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6720 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6721 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6722 header and requires different one.
6723
6724 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6725 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6726 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6727 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6728 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6729 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6730 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6731
6732 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6733 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6734 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6735 both are defined.
6736
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006737 Examples :
6738 # Original Destination address
6739 frontend www
6740 mode http
6741 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6742
6743 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6744 backend www
6745 mode http
6746 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6747
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006748 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006749
6750
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006751option persist
6752no option persist
6753 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006756 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006757
6758 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6759 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6760 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6761 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6762 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6763 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6764 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6765 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6766 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6767 redirected to another valid server.
6768
6769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6771
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006772 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006773
6774
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006775option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6776 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
6779 Arguments :
6780 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6781 PostgreSQL server.
6782
6783 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6784 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6785 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6786 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6787
6788 See also: "option httpchk"
6789
6790
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006791option prefer-last-server
6792no option prefer-last-server
6793 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6795 yes | no | yes | yes
6796 Arguments : none
6797
6798 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6799 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6800 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6801 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6802 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6803 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6804 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6805 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6806 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006807 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6808 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006809 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6810 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6811 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006812 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6813 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6814 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006815
6816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6818
6819 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6820
6821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006822option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006823option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006824no option redispatch
6825 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006828 Arguments :
6829 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6830 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6831 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006832 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006833 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006834 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006835 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6836 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6837 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006839
6840 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6841 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6842 be able to access the service anymore.
6843
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006844 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6845 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006846
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006847 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006848 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6849 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006851 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6852 "redisp" keywords.
6853
6854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6856
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006857 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006858
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006859
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006860option redis-check
6861 Use redis health checks for server testing
6862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6863 yes | no | yes | yes
6864 Arguments : none
6865
6866 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6867 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6868 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6869 find the "+PONG" response message.
6870
6871 Example :
6872 option redis-check
6873
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006874 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006875
6876
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006877option smtpchk
6878option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6879 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006882 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006883 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006884 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006885 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6886
6887 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6888 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6889 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6890
6891 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6892 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6893 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6894 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6895 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6896 dead server.
6897
6898 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6899 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006900 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006901 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6902
6903 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6904 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6905 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6906 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006907 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006908
6909 Example :
6910 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6911
6912 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006915option socket-stats
6916no option socket-stats
6917
6918 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | no
6921
6922 Arguments : none
6923
6924
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006925option splice-auto
6926no option splice-auto
6927 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6929 yes | yes | yes | yes
6930 Arguments : none
6931
6932 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6933 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006934 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006935 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006936 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006937 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6938 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6939 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6940 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6941
6942 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6943 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6944 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6945 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6946 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6947 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6948 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6949 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6950 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6951 keyword.
6952
6953 Example :
6954 option splice-auto
6955
6956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6958
6959 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6960 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6961
6962
6963option splice-request
6964no option splice-request
6965 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 yes | yes | yes | yes
6968 Arguments : none
6969
6970 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006971 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006972 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6973 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6974 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6975 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6976
6977 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6978
6979 Example :
6980 option splice-request
6981
6982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6984
6985 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6986 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6987
6988
6989option splice-response
6990no option splice-response
6991 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | yes | yes | yes
6994 Arguments : none
6995
6996 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006997 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006998 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6999 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7000 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7001 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7002
7003 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7004
7005 Example :
7006 option splice-response
7007
7008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7010
7011 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7012 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7013
7014
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007015option spop-check
7016 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 no | no | no | yes
7019 Arguments : none
7020
7021 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7022 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7023 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7024 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7025
7026 Example :
7027 option spop-check
7028
7029 See also : "option httpchk"
7030
7031
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007032option srvtcpka
7033no option srvtcpka
7034 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | no | yes | yes
7037 Arguments : none
7038
7039 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7040 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007041 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007042 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7043
7044 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7045 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7046 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7047 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7048
7049 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7050 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7051 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7052 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7053 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7054
7055 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7056
7057 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7058 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7059 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7060
7061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7063
7064 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7065
7066
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007067option ssl-hello-chk
7068 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7070 yes | no | yes | yes
7071 Arguments : none
7072
7073 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7074 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7075 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7076 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7077 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7078 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7079 hello message.
7080
7081 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7082 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7083 messages, which is appreciable.
7084
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007085 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7086 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7087 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007088
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007089 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7090
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007091
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007092option tcp-check
7093 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7095 yes | no | yes | yes
7096
7097 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7098 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7099
7100 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7101 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7102 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7103
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007104 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007105 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7106 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7107 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7108 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7109 only.
7110
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007111 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007112 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7113 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7114 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7115 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7116
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007117 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007118 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7119 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007120 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007121 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7122 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7123 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7124 the respective protocols.
7125 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007126 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007127
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007128 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7129 script.
7130
7131 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7132 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7133 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7134 The "comment" is of course optional.
7135
7136
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007137 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007138 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007139 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007140 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007142 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007143 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007144 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007145
7146 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7147 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007148 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007149 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007150 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007151 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007152 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007153 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007154 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7155 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007156 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007157 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7158 tcp-check expect string +OK
7159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007160 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007161 (send many headers before analyzing)
7162 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007163 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007164 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7165 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7166 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7167 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007168 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007169
7170
7171 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7172
7173
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007174option tcp-smart-accept
7175no option tcp-smart-accept
7176 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7178 yes | yes | yes | no
7179 Arguments : none
7180
7181 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7182 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7183 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7184 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7185 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7186 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7187
7188 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7189 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7190 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7191 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7192
7193 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7194 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7195 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007196 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007197
7198 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7199 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7200 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7201
7202 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7203 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7204 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7205
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007206 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7207
7208
7209option tcp-smart-connect
7210no option tcp-smart-connect
7211 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 yes | no | yes | yes
7214 Arguments : none
7215
7216 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7217 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7218 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7219 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7220 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7221
7222 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7223 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7224 complex.
7225
7226 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7227 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7228 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7229
7230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7232
7233 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7234
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007235
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007236option tcpka
7237 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | yes | yes | yes
7240 Arguments : none
7241
7242 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7243 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007244 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007245 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7246
7247 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7248 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7249 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7250 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7251
7252 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7253 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7254 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7255 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7256 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7257
7258 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7259
7260 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7261 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7262 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7263 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7264 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7265 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7266 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7267 backends.
7268
7269 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7270
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007271
7272option tcplog
7273 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007275 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007276 Arguments : none
7277
7278 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7279 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7280 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7281 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7282 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7283 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7284 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7285 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7286
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007287 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007289 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007290
7291
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007292option transparent
7293no option transparent
7294 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007296 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007297 Arguments : none
7298
7299 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7300 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7301 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7302 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7303 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7304 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7305 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7306 appropriate server.
7307
7308 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7309 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7310
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007311 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007312 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007313
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007314
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007315external-check command <command>
7316 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319
7320 Arguments :
7321 <command> is the external command to run
7322
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007323 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7324
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007325 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007326
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007327 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7328 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7329 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7330 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7331 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7332 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007333
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007334 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7335
7336 Environment variables :
7337 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7338 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7339
7340 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7341
7342 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7343
7344 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7345 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7346 for a UNIX socket).
7347
7348 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7349
7350 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7351
7352 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7353
7354 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7355
7356 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7357
7358 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7359 socket).
7360
7361 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7362 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7363
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007364 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7365 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7366 failed.
7367
7368 Example :
7369 external-check command /bin/true
7370
7371 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7372
7373
7374external-check path <path>
7375 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7377 yes | no | yes | yes
7378
7379 Arguments :
7380 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7381
7382 The default path is "".
7383
7384 Example :
7385 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7386
7387 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7388 "external-check command"
7389
7390
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007391persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007392persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007393 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
7396 Arguments :
7397 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007398 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7399 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007400
7401 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7402 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007403 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007404 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7405 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7406 forwarded to this server.
7407
7408 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7409 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7410 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007411 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007412 a single "listen" section.
7413
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007414 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7415 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7416 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7417
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007418 Example :
7419 listen tse-farm
7420 bind :3389
7421 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7422 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7423 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7424 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7425 persist rdp-cookie
7426 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007427 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007428 balance rdp-cookie
7429 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7430 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7431
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007432 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7433 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007434
7435
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007436rate-limit sessions <rate>
7437 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7439 yes | yes | yes | no
7440 Arguments :
7441 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7442 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7443
7444 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7445 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7446 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7447 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7448 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7449 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7450
7451 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7452 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7453 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7454 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7455
7456 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7457 listen smtp
7458 mode tcp
7459 bind :25
7460 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007461 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007462
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007463 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7464 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7465 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007466
7467 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7468
7469
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007470redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7471redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7472redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007473 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 no | yes | yes | yes
7476
7477 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007478 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007479
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007481 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007482 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7483 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7484 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007485
7486 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7487 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7488 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7489 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7490 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007491 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7492 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7493 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7494 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007495
7496 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7497 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7498 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7499 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7500 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7501 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007502 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007503 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007504 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7505 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7506 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007507
7508 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007509 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7510 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7511 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007512 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007513 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7514 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7515 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7516 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007517
7518 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007520
7521 - "drop-query"
7522 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7523 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7524 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7525 with a location-type redirect.
7526
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007527 - "append-slash"
7528 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7529 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7530 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7531 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7532
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007533 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7534 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7535 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7536 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7537 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7538 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7539 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7540
7541 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7542 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7543 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7544 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7545 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7546 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7547 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007548
7549 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7550 acl clear dst_port 80
7551 acl secure dst_port 8080
7552 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007553 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007554 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007555 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7556
7557 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007558 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7559 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7560 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007561 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007562
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007563 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7564 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7565 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7566
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007567 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007568 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007569
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007570 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007571 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7572 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7573 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007575 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007576
7577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007578redisp (deprecated)
7579redispatch (deprecated)
7580 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007583 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007584
7585 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7586 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7587 be able to access the service anymore.
7588
7589 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7590 redistribute them to a working server.
7591
7592 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7593 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7594 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007596 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7597 "option redispatch" instead.
7598
7599 See also : "option redispatch"
7600
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007601
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007602reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007603 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 no | yes | yes | yes
7606 Arguments :
7607 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7608 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007609 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007610
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007611 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7612 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7613
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007614 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7615 the last header of an HTTP request.
7616
7617 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7618 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7619 responses.
7620
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007621 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7622 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7623 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7624
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007625 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7626 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007627
7628
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007629reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7630reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007631 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 no | yes | yes | yes
7634 Arguments :
7635 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7636 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7637 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7638 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7639 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7640 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7641 ignores case.
7642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007643 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7644 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7645
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7647 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7648 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7649 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007650 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007651
7652 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7653 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7654
7655 Example :
7656 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7657 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7658 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7659
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007660 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7661 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007662
7663
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007664reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7665reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 no | yes | yes | yes
7669 Arguments :
7670 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7671 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7672 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7673 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7674 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7675 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7676
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007677 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7678 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7679
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007680 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7681 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7682 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7683 next servers.
7684
7685 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7686 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7687 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7688
7689 Example :
7690 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7691 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7692 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7693
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007694 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7695 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007696
7697
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007698reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7699reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007700 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7702 no | yes | yes | yes
7703 Arguments :
7704 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7705 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7706 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7707 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7708 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7709 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7710 case.
7711
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007712 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7713 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7714
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007715 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7716 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7717 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7718 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007719 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007720
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007721 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007722 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007723 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007725 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7726 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7727
7728 Example :
7729 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7730 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7731 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7732
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007733 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7734 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007735
7736
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007737reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7738reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007739 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7741 no | yes | yes | yes
7742 Arguments :
7743 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7744 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7745 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7746 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7747 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7748 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7749 case.
7750
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007751 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7752 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7753
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007754 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7755 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7756 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7757 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7758
7759 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7760 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7761
7762 Example :
7763 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7764 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7765 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7766 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7767
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007768 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7769 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007770
7771
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007772reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7773reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007774 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 no | yes | yes | yes
7777 Arguments :
7778 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7779 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7780 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7781 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7782 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7783 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7784
7785 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7786 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7787 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7788 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007789 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007791 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7792 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7793
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007794 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7795 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7796 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7797
7798 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7799 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7800 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7801 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7802 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7803
7804 Example :
7805 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007806 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007807 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7808 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7809
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007810 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7811 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007812
7813
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007814reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7815reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007816 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 no | yes | yes | yes
7819 Arguments :
7820 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7821 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7822 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7823 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7824 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7825 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7826 ignores case.
7827
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007828 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7829 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7830
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007831 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7832 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007833 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7834 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7835 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007836 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7837 not set.
7838
7839 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7840 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7841 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7842 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7843 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7844
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007845 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007846 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007847 # block all others.
7848 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7849 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7850
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007851 # block bad guys
7852 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7853 reqitarpit . if badguys
7854
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007855 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7856 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007857
7858
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007859retries <value>
7860 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 yes | no | yes | yes
7863 Arguments :
7864 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7865 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7866 default value is 3.
7867
7868 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7869 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7870 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7871
7872 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007873 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7874 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007875
7876 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7877 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7878
7879 See also : "option redispatch"
7880
7881
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007882rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007883 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 no | yes | yes | yes
7886 Arguments :
7887 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7888 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007889 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007891 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7892 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7893
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007894 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7895 the last header of an HTTP response.
7896
7897 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7898 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7899 responses.
7900
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007901 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7902 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007903
7904
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007905rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7906rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007907 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7909 no | yes | yes | yes
7910 Arguments :
7911 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7912 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7913 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7914 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7915 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7916 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7917 ignores case.
7918
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007919 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7920 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7921
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7923 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007924 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007925 client.
7926
7927 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7928 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7929 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7930
7931 Example :
7932 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007933 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007934
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007935 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7936 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007937
7938
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007939rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7940rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007941 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7943 no | yes | yes | yes
7944 Arguments :
7945 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7946 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7947 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7948 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7949 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7950 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7951 ignores case.
7952
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007953 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7954 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7955
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007956 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7957 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7958 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7959 case-sensitive.
7960
7961 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007962 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7963 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7964 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007965
7966 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7967 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7968
7969 Example :
7970 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7971 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7972
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007973 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7974 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007975
7976
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007977rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7978rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7981 no | yes | yes | yes
7982 Arguments :
7983 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7984 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7985 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7986 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7987 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7988 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7989 ignores case.
7990
7991 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7992 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7993 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7994 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007995 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007996
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007997 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7998 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7999
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008000 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8001 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8002 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8003
8004 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8005 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8006 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8007 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8008 are not case-sensitive.
8009
8010 Example :
8011 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8012 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8013
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008014 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8015 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008016
8017
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008018server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008019 Declare a server in a backend
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 no | no | yes | yes
8022 Arguments :
8023 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008024 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008025 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008026
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008027 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8028 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8029 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8030 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008031 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8032 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8033 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8034 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8035 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008036 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8037 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8038 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8039 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8040 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8041 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8042 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008043 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008044 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8045 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8046 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8047 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8048 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8049 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008050 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8051 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008052 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8053 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008055 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008056 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8057 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8058 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8059 adding this value to the client's port.
8060
8061 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8062 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064
8065 Examples :
8066 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8067 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008068 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008069 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8070 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8071 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008072
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008073 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8074 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8075 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8076 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8077 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8078
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008079 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8080 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008081
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008082server-state-file-name [<file>]
8083 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8084 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8085 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8086 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8087 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8088 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8089
8090 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8091 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8092
8093 global
8094 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8095
8096 backend bk
8097 load-server-state-from-file
8098
8099 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8100 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008102server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8103 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8104 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 no | no | yes | yes
8107
8108 Arguments:
8109 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8110
8111 <num | range>
8112 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8113 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8114 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8115 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8116
8117 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8118
8119 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8120
8121 <params*>
8122 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8123 keyword.
8124
8125 Examples:
8126 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8127 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8128 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8129
8130 # or
8131 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8132
8133 # would be equivalent to:
8134 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8135 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8136 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8137
8138
8139
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008141source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008142source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008143 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 yes | no | yes | yes
8146 Arguments :
8147 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8148 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008149
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008150 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008151 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8152 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8153 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8154 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8155 supported prefixes are :
8156 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8157 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8158 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008159 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008160 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8161 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162
8163 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8164 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008165 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8166 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8167 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168
8169 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8170 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8171 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8172 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8173 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8174 <addr>.
8175
8176 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8177 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8178 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8179 port.
8180
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008181 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8182 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8183 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8184 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008185 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008186 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8187 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8188 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8189 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8190 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8191 HTTP header.
8192
8193 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8194 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008195 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008196 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8197 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8198 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8199 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8200 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8201 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8202 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8203
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008204 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8205 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8206 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8207 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8208 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8209 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8210
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008211 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8212 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8213 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8214 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8215
8216 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8217 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8218 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8219 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8220 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8221 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8222
8223 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8224 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8225 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8226 there are two methods :
8227
8228 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8229 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8230 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8231 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8232 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8233 of the client ranges may be used.
8234
8235 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8236 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8237 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8238 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8239 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8240 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8241 same session.
8242
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008243 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8244 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8245 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008246 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008247
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008248 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8249
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008250 Examples :
8251 backend private
8252 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8253 source 192.168.1.200
8254
8255 backend transparent_ssl1
8256 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8257 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8258
8259 backend transparent_ssl2
8260 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8261 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8262 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8263
8264 backend transparent_ssl3
8265 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8266 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8267 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8268
8269 backend transparent_smtp
8270 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8271 # with Tproxy version 4.
8272 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8273
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008274 backend transparent_http
8275 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8276 # proxy.
8277 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008279 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008280 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008282
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008283srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8284 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8286 yes | no | yes | yes
8287 Arguments :
8288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8290 as explained at the top of this document.
8291
8292 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8293 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8294 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8295 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8296 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8297 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8298 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8299
8300 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8301 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8302 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8303 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8304 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008305 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008306 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008307 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008308
8309 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8310 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8311 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8312 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8313 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8314 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8315
8316 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8317 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8318
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008319 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8320 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008321
8322
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008323stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8324 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008326 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008327
8328 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8329 matched.
8330
8331 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8332 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8333
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008334 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8335 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008337
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008338 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8339 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8340 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8341 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008342
8343 Example :
8344 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8345 backend stats_localhost
8346 stats enable
8347 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8348
8349 Example :
8350 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8351 backend stats_auth
8352 stats enable
8353 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8354 stats admin if TRUE
8355
8356 Example :
8357 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8358 userlist stats-auth
8359 group admin users admin
8360 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8361 group readonly users haproxy
8362 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8363
8364 backend stats_auth
8365 stats enable
8366 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8367 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8368 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8369 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8370
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008371 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8372 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8373 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008374
8375
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008376stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8377 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380 Arguments :
8381 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8382
8383 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8384
8385 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8386 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8387 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8388 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8389 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8390 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8391
8392 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8393 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8394 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008395 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396
8397 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8398 report using "stats scope".
8399
8400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8402 unobvious parameters.
8403
8404 Example :
8405 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8406 backend public_www
8407 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8408 stats enable
8409 stats hide-version
8410 stats scope .
8411 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008412 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008413 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8414 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8415
8416 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8417 backend private_monitoring
8418 stats enable
8419 stats uri /admin?stats
8420 stats refresh 5s
8421
8422 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8423
8424
8425stats enable
8426 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008429 Arguments : none
8430
8431 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8432 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8433 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8434 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8435 - stats auth : no authentication
8436 - stats scope : no restriction
8437
8438 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8439 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8440 unobvious parameters.
8441
8442 Example :
8443 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8444 backend public_www
8445 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8446 stats enable
8447 stats hide-version
8448 stats scope .
8449 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008450 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008451 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8452 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8453
8454 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8455 backend private_monitoring
8456 stats enable
8457 stats uri /admin?stats
8458 stats refresh 5s
8459
8460 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8461
8462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008463stats hide-version
8464 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008466 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008467 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008469 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8470 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8471 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8472 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8473 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8474 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8478 unobvious parameters.
8479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008480 Example :
8481 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8482 backend public_www
8483 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008484 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008485 stats hide-version
8486 stats scope .
8487 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008488 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008489 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8490 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008491
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008492 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8493 backend private_monitoring
8494 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008495 stats uri /admin?stats
8496 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008499
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008500
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008501stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8503 Access control for statistics
8504
8505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 no | no | yes | yes
8507
8508 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8509 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8510 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8511 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8512 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8513 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8514
8515 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8516 instance.
8517
8518 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8519 about ACL usage.
8520
8521
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008522stats realm <realm>
8523 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008525 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008526 Arguments :
8527 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8528 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8529 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8530
8531 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8532 using a backslash ('\').
8533
8534 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8535 only related to authentication.
8536
8537 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8538 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8539 unobvious parameters.
8540
8541 Example :
8542 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8543 backend public_www
8544 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8545 stats enable
8546 stats hide-version
8547 stats scope .
8548 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008549 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008550 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8551 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8552
8553 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8554 backend private_monitoring
8555 stats enable
8556 stats uri /admin?stats
8557 stats refresh 5s
8558
8559 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8560
8561
8562stats refresh <delay>
8563 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008565 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008566 Arguments :
8567 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8568 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8569 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8570 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8571 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8572 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8573
8574 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8575 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8576 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8577 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8578
8579 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8580 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8581 unobvious parameters.
8582
8583 Example :
8584 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8585 backend public_www
8586 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8587 stats enable
8588 stats hide-version
8589 stats scope .
8590 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008591 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008592 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8593 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8594
8595 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8596 backend private_monitoring
8597 stats enable
8598 stats uri /admin?stats
8599 stats refresh 5s
8600
8601 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8602
8603
8604stats scope { <name> | "." }
8605 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008607 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608 Arguments :
8609 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8610 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8611 section in which the statement appears.
8612
8613 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8614 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8615 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8616 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8617 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8618 exists.
8619
8620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8622 unobvious parameters.
8623
8624 Example :
8625 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8626 backend public_www
8627 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8628 stats enable
8629 stats hide-version
8630 stats scope .
8631 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008632 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008633 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8634 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8635
8636 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8637 backend private_monitoring
8638 stats enable
8639 stats uri /admin?stats
8640 stats refresh 5s
8641
8642 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8643
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008645stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008649
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008650 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008651 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8652
8653 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8654 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8655
8656 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8657 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008658 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008659
8660 Example :
8661 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8662 backend private_monitoring
8663 stats enable
8664 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8665 stats uri /admin?stats
8666 stats refresh 5s
8667
8668 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8669 global section.
8670
8671
8672stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008673 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8675 yes | yes | yes | yes
8676 Arguments : none
8677
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008678 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008679 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8680 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8681 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8682 - IP (socket, server)
8683 - cookie (backend, server)
8684
8685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008687 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688
8689 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8690
8691
8692stats show-node [ <name> ]
8693 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008695 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008696 Arguments:
8697 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8698 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8699
8700 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8701 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008703
8704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8706 unobvious parameters.
8707
8708 Example:
8709 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8710 backend private_monitoring
8711 stats enable
8712 stats show-node Europe-1
8713 stats uri /admin?stats
8714 stats refresh 5s
8715
8716 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8717 section.
8718
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719
8720stats uri <prefix>
8721 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724 Arguments :
8725 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8726 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8727 query string.
8728
8729 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8730 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8731 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8732 possible to reach it in the application.
8733
8734 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008735 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008736 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8737 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8738 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8739 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8740
8741 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8742 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8743 an address or a port to statistics only.
8744
8745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8747 unobvious parameters.
8748
8749 Example :
8750 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8751 backend public_www
8752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8753 stats enable
8754 stats hide-version
8755 stats scope .
8756 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008758 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8759 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8760
8761 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8762 backend private_monitoring
8763 stats enable
8764 stats uri /admin?stats
8765 stats refresh 5s
8766
8767 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8768
8769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8771 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008773 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774
8775 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008776 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008777 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008778 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008779 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8780
8781 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8782 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8783 the "stick-table" statement.
8784
8785 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8786 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8787 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8788 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8789 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8790
8791 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8792 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8793 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8794 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8795 transformation rules.
8796
8797 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8798 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8799 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8800 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8801 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8802 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8803 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8804
8805 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8806 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8807 ACL based conditions.
8808
8809 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8810 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8811 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8812 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8813
8814 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8815 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8816 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8817 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008819 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8820 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008822
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823 Example :
8824 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8825 # last 30 minutes
8826 backend pop
8827 mode tcp
8828 balance roundrobin
8829 stick store-request src
8830 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8831 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8832 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8833
8834 backend smtp
8835 mode tcp
8836 balance roundrobin
8837 stick match src table pop
8838 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8839 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8840
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008841 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008842 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008843
8844
8845stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8846 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 no | no | yes | yes
8849
8850 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8851 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8852 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8853 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8854
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008855 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8856 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008857 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008858
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008859 Examples :
8860 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008861 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008862
8863 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8864 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8865 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8866
8867
8868 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8869 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8870 backend http
8871 mode http
8872 balance roundrobin
8873 stick on src table https
8874 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8875 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8876 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8877
8878 backend https
8879 mode tcp
8880 balance roundrobin
8881 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8882 stick on src
8883 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8884 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8885
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008886 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008887
8888
8889stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8890 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 no | no | yes | yes
8893
8894 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008895 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008896 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008898 server is selected.
8899
8900 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8901 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8902 the "stick-table" statement.
8903
8904 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8905 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8906 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8907 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8908 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8909 address.
8910
8911 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8912 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8913 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8914 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8915 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8916 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8917 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8918 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8919 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8920 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8921
8922 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8923 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8924 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8925 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8926 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8927 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8928 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8929
8930 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8931 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8932 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8933 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8934
8935 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8936 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8937 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8938 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8939 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8940 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008941 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8942 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8943 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8944 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8945 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8946 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008947
8948 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8949 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8950 the request.
8951
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008952 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8953 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008955
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008956 Example :
8957 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8958 # last 30 minutes
8959 backend pop
8960 mode tcp
8961 balance roundrobin
8962 stick store-request src
8963 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8964 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8965 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8966
8967 backend smtp
8968 mode tcp
8969 balance roundrobin
8970 stick match src table pop
8971 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8972 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8973
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008974 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008975 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976
8977
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008978stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008979 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8980 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008981 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008983 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984
8985 Arguments :
8986 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8987 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8988 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8989 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8990
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008991 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8992 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8993 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8994 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008996 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8997 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8998 instance.
8999
9000 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9001 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9002 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9003 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9004 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9005 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009006 to 32 characters.
9007
9008 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9009 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9010 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009011 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009012 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9013 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009014
9015 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009016 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9017 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009018 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9019 increase.
9020
9021 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009022 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9023 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9024 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009025
9026 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9027 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9028 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9029 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009031 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9032 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9033 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9034 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9035 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9036 parameter (see below).
9037
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009038 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9039 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9040 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9041 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9042 soft restart.
9043
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009044 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9045 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009046
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009047 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9048 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9049 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9050 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009051 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009052 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009053 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9054 if not expiration delay is specified.
9055
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009056 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9057 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9058 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9059 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009060 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9061 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9062 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9063 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9064 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9065 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9066 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9067 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9068 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9069 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9070 types and their arguments.
9071
9072 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9073 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9074 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9075 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9076
9077 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9078 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9079 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009081
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009082 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9083 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9084 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009085 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009086 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009088
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009089 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9090 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9091 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9092 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9093
9094 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9095 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9096 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9097 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9098 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9099 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009101 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9102 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9103 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9104 they were received.
9105
9106 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9107 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9108 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9109 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9110 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9111
9112 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9113 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9114 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9115 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9116 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9117
9118 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9119 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9120 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9121
9122 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9123 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9124 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9125 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9126 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9127
9128 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9129 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9130 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9131 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9132 the client side.
9133
9134 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9135 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9136 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9137 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9138 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9139 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9140 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9141
9142 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9143 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9144 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9145 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9146 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9147 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009148 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009149
9150 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9151 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9152 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9153 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9154 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9155 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9156
9157 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009158 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009159 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9160 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9161
9162 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9163 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9164 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9165 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9166 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9167 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9168 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9169 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9170 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9171 recommended for better fairness.
9172
9173 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009175 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9176 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9177
9178 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9179 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9180 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9181 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9182 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9183 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9184 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9185 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9186 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9187 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009188
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009189 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9190 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009191 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9192 reference it.
9193
9194 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9195 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009196 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9197 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9198 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009199
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009200 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9201 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9202 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9203 something that can be ignored.
9204
9205 Example:
9206 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9207 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9208 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9209 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9210
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009211 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009212 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009213
9214
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009215stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009216 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 no | no | yes | yes
9219
9220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009221 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009222 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009224 server is selected.
9225
9226 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9227 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9228 the "stick-table" statement.
9229
9230 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9231 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9232 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9233 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9234
9235 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9236 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9237 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9238 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9239 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9240 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009241 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009242 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9243 rules.
9244
9245 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9246 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9247 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9248 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9249 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9250 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9251 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9252
9253 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9254 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9255 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9256 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9257
9258 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9259 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9260 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9261 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9262 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9263 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009264 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9265 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9266 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9267 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9268 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9269 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9270 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9271 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9272 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009273
9274 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9275
9276 Example :
9277 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9278 backend https
9279 mode tcp
9280 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009281 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009282 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009283
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009284 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9285 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9286
9287 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9288 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9289 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9290
9291 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9292 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009293
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009294 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9295 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9296 # at offset 44.
9297
9298 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9299 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9300
9301 # Learn on response if server hello.
9302 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009303
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009304 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9305 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9306
9307 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9308 extraction.
9309
9310
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009311tcp-check connect [params*]
9312 Opens a new connection
9313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 no | no | yes | yes
9315
9316 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9317 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9318 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9319
9320 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9321 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9322 of the sequence.
9323
9324 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9325 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9326 do.
9327
9328 Parameters :
9329 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9330 use the TCP connection.
9331
9332 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9333 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9334 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9335
9336 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9337
9338 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9339
9340 Examples:
9341 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9342 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9343 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9344 option tcp-check
9345 tcp-check connect
9346 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9347 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9348 tcp-check send \r\n
9349 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9350 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9351 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9352 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9353 tcp-check send \r\n
9354 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9355 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9356
9357 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9358 option tcp-check
9359 tcp-check connect port 110
9360 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9361 tcp-check connect port 143
9362 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9363 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9364
9365 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9366
9367
9368tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009369 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9371 no | no | yes | yes
9372
9373 Arguments :
9374 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9375 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9376 binary.
9377 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9378 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9379 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9380
9381 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9382 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9383 with the usual backslash ('\').
9384 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009385 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009386 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9387 used upper or lower case.
9388
9389
9390 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9391
9392 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9393 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9394 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9395 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9396 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9397 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9398 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9399 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9400
9401 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9403 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9404 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9405 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9406 expression.
9407
9408 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9409 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9410 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9411 this exact hexadecimal string.
9412 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9413
9414 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9415 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9416 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9417 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9418 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9419 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9420 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9421 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9422 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9423 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9424 the null character.
9425
9426 Examples :
9427 # perform a POP check
9428 option tcp-check
9429 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9430
9431 # perform an IMAP check
9432 option tcp-check
9433 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9434
9435 # look for the redis master server
9436 option tcp-check
9437 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009438 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009439 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9440 tcp-check expect string role:master
9441 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9442 tcp-check expect string +OK
9443
9444
9445 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9446 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9447
9448
9449tcp-check send <data>
9450 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9451 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9452 no | no | yes | yes
9453
9454 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9455 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9456
9457 Examples :
9458 # look for the redis master server
9459 option tcp-check
9460 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9461 tcp-check expect string role:master
9462
9463 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9464 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9465
9466
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009467tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9468 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009469 tcp health check
9470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 no | no | yes | yes
9472
9473 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9474 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009475 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009476 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9477 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9478 hexadecimal string.
9479 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9480
9481 Examples :
9482 # redis check in binary
9483 option tcp-check
9484 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9485 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9486
9487
9488 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9489 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9490
9491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009492tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9493 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009497 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9498 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009500 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
9502 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9503 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009504 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9505 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9506 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9507 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9508 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9509 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009511 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9512 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9513 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9514 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009515
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009516 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009517 - accept :
9518 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9519 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9520 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 - reject :
9523 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9524 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9525 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9526 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9527 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9528 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9529 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9530 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9531 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9532 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9533 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009534 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009535
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009536 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9537 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9538 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9539 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9540 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9541 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9542 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9543 hosts.
9544
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009545 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9546 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9547 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9548 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9549 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9550 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9551 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9552 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9553
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009554 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9555 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9556 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9557 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9558 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9559 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9560 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9561 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9562 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009563 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9564 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009565
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009566 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009567 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009568 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9569 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9570 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9571 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9572 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9573 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9574 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9575 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9576 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9577 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9578 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9579 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009581 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009582 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009584 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009585 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9586 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9587 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9590 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9591 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9592 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9595 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9596 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9597 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9598 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009599 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9600 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9601 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9602 layer7 information is extracted.
9603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009604 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9605 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9606 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9607 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9608 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009609
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009610 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9611 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9612 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9613 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9614
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009615 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9616 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9617 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9618 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9619
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009620 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9621 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9622 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9623 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9624 continues.
9625
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009626 - set-src <expr> :
9627 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9628 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9629 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009630 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009631
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009632 Arguments:
9633 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9634 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009635
9636 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009637 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9638
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009639 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9640 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009641
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009642 - set-src-port <expr> :
9643 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9644 expression.
9645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009646 Arguments:
9647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9648 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009649
9650 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009651 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9652
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009653 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9654 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9655 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009656
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009657 - set-dst <expr> :
9658 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9659 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9660 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9661 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9662 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9663
9664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9665 followed by some converters.
9666
9667 Example:
9668
9669 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9670 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9671
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009672 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9673 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9674
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009675 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9676 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9677 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9678 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9679
9680
9681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9682 followed by some converters.
9683
9684 Example:
9685
9686 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9687
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009688 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9689 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9690 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9691
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009692 - "silent-drop" :
9693 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009694 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009695 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9696 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9697 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9698 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9699 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009700 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9701 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009702 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9703 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009704 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009705 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9706 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9707 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9708 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9709
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009710 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9711 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9712 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009714 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9715 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9716 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009718 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009719 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009720 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009722 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9723 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9724 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009726 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009727 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9728 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009729
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009730 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9731
9732 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9733
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009734 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9735
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009736 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009737
9738
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009739tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9740 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009742 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009743 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009744 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9745 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009747 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009749 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009750 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9751 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9752 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9753 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009754
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009755 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9756 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9757 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9758 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009759 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9760 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9761 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9762 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9763 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9764 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009765 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009766 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9769 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9770 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9771 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009773 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009774 - accept : the request is accepted
9775 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9776 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009777 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009778 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009779 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009780 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009781 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009782 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009783 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009784 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009785 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9788 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009789
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009790 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9791 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9792 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9793 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9794 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9795 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009797 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9799 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009801 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009802 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9803 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9804 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9805 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009806 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9807 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9808 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009809
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009810 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009811 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9812 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9813 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009814
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009815 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009816 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9817 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009818
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009819 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9820 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009824 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009826 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9828 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009829 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009830 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9831 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009832
9833 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9834 followed by some converters.
9835
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009836 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9837 <var-name>.
9838
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009839 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9840 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9841 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9842 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9843 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9844
9845 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9846 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9847 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9848 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9849 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9850 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9851 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9852 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9853 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9854 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9855 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9856
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009857 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9858 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9859 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9860 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9861 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9862
9863 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9864
9865 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9866
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009867 Example:
9868
9869 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009870 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009871
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009872 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009873 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9874 # and reject everything else.
9875 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9876 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009877 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009878 tcp-request content reject
9879
9880 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009881 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9882 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9883 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009884 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009885
9886 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9887 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9888 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009889 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009890 tcp-request content reject
9891
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009892 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009893 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009894 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009895 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009896 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9897 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009898
9899 Example:
9900 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9901 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009902 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009903
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009904 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009905 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009906
9907 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009908 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009909 # protecting all our sites
9910 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009911 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9912 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009913 ...
9914 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9915
9916 backend http_dynamic
9917 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009918 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009919 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009920 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009921 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009922 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009925 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009926
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009927 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9928 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009929
9930
9931tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9932 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009934 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009935 Arguments :
9936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9938 as explained at the top of this document.
9939
9940 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9941 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9942 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9943 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9944 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9945
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009946 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9947 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9948 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9949 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9950
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009951 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9952 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009953 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009954 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009955 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9956 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9957 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9958 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009959
9960 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9961 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9962 it pass through unaffected.
9963
9964 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9965 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9966 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009967 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009968 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9969 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009970 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9971 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9972 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009973
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009974 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009975 "timeout client".
9976
9977
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009978tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9979 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9981 no | no | yes | yes
9982 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009983 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9984 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009985
9986 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009988 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009989 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9990 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009991 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9992 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009993
9994 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9995
9996 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9997 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9998 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9999 inserted.
10000
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010001 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010002 - accept :
10003 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10004 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10005 the rules evaluation.
10006
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010007 - close :
10008 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10009 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10010 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10011 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10012 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10013 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010014 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010015 protocols.
10016
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010017 - reject :
10018 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10019 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010020 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010021
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010022 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10023 Sets a variable.
10024
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010025 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10026 Unsets a variable.
10027
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010028 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10029 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10030 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10031 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10032
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010033 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10034 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10035 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10036 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10037
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010038 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10039 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10040 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10041 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10042 continues.
10043
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010044 - "silent-drop" :
10045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010046 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010047 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10048 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10049 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10050 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10051 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010052 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10053 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010054 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10055 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010056 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010057 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10058 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10059 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10060 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10061
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010062 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10063 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10064
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010065 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10066 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10067 for changing the default action to a reject.
10068
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010069 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10070 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10071 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10072 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010073 period.
10074
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010075 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10076 declared inline.
10077
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010078 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10079 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010080 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010081 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10082 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010083 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010084 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010085 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010086 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10087 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010088 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010089 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10090 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010091
10092 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10093 followed by some converters.
10094
10095 Example:
10096
10097 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10098
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010099 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10100 <var-name>.
10101
10102 Example:
10103
10104 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10105
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010106 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10107 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10108 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10109 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10110 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10111
10112 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10113
10114 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10115
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010116 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10117
10118 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10119
10120
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010121tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10122 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10124 no | yes | yes | no
10125 Arguments :
10126 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10127 below.
10128
10129 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010131 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010132 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10133 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10134 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10135 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10136 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10137 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10138 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010139 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010140 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10141 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10142 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10143 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10144 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10145 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10146 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10147 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10148 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10149 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10150 instead.
10151
10152 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10153 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10154 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10155 rules which may be inserted.
10156
10157 Several types of actions are supported :
10158 - accept : the request is accepted
10159 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10160 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10161 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010162 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010163 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10164 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010165 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010166 - silent-drop
10167
10168 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10169 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10170 sections for a complete description.
10171
10172 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10173 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10174 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10175
10176 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10177 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10178 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10179 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10180 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10181
10182 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10183 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10184
10185 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10186 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10187 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10188
10189 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10190 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10191 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10192
10193 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10194 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10195 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10196
10197 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10198 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10199 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10200
10201 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10202
10203 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10204
10205
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010206tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10207 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10209 no | no | yes | yes
10210 Arguments :
10211 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10212 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10213 as explained at the top of this document.
10214
10215 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10216
10217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010218timeout check <timeout>
10219 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10220 established.
10221
10222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10223 yes | no | yes | yes
10224 Arguments:
10225 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10226 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10227 as explained at the top of this document.
10228
10229 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10230 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010231 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010232 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010233 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10234 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10235 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010236
10237 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10238 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10239
10240 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10241 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010242 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010243
10244 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10245 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10246 forget about it.
10247
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010248 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10249 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010250
10251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010252timeout client <timeout>
10253timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10254 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10256 yes | yes | yes | no
10257 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010258 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010259 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10260 as explained at the top of this document.
10261
10262 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10263 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10264 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010265 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10266 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10267 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10268 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010269 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10270 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10271 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010272 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010273 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10275 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010276 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10277 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010278
10279 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10280 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10281 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10282 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10283 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10284 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10285
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010286 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010288 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10289 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10290 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10291
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010292 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10293 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010294
10295
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010296timeout client-fin <timeout>
10297 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10299 yes | yes | yes | no
10300 Arguments :
10301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10303 as explained at the top of this document.
10304
10305 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10306 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10307 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10308 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10309 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10310 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10311 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010312 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10313 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10314 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010315
10316 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10317 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10318 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10319
10320 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10321
10322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010323timeout connect <timeout>
10324timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10325 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10327 yes | no | yes | yes
10328 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10331 as explained at the top of this document.
10332
10333 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010334 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010335 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010336 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010337 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10338 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010339
10340 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10341 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10342 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10343 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10344 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10345 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10346
10347 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10348 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10349 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10350
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010351 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10352 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010353
10354
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010355timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10356 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10358 yes | yes | yes | yes
10359 Arguments :
10360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10362 as explained at the top of this document.
10363
10364 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10365 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10366 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10367 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10368 once the request has started to present itself.
10369
10370 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10371 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10372 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10373 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10374 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10375
10376 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10377 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10378 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10379 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10380
10381 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10382 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010383 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010384 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10385 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010386 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010387
10388 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10389 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10390 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10391 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10392
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010393 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10394 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010395 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10396
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010397 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10398
10399
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010400timeout http-request <timeout>
10401 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010403 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10407 as explained at the top of this document.
10408
10409 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10410 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10411 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10412 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10413 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10414 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10415 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010416 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10417 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10418 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10419 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010420 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010421 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10422 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010423
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010424 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10425 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10426 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10427 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10428 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010429 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010430
10431 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10432 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010433 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010434 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10435 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10436
10437 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010438 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10439 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10440 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010441
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010442 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010443 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010444
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010445
10446timeout queue <timeout>
10447 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10449 yes | no | yes | yes
10450 Arguments :
10451 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10452 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10453 as explained at the top of this document.
10454
10455 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10456 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10457 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10458 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10459 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10460
10461 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10462 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10463 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10464 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10465
10466 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10467
10468
10469timeout server <timeout>
10470timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10471 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10473 yes | no | yes | yes
10474 Arguments :
10475 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10477 as explained at the top of this document.
10478
10479 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10480 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10481 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10482 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10483 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10484 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10485 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10486
10487 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10488 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10489 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10490 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10491 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010492 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010493 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010494 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10495 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010496 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10497 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010498
10499 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10500 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10501 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10502 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10503 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10504 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10505
10506 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10507 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10508 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10509
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010510 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010511
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010512
10513timeout server-fin <timeout>
10514 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | no | yes | yes
10517 Arguments :
10518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10520 as explained at the top of this document.
10521
10522 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10523 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10524 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10525 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10526 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10527 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10528 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10529 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10530 situations, it should not be needed.
10531
10532 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10533 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10534 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10535
10536 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10537
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010538
10539timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010540 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10542 yes | yes | yes | yes
10543 Arguments :
10544 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10545 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10546 as explained at the top of this document.
10547
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010548 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10549 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10550 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10551 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010552
10553 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10554 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10555 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10556 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010557 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010558
10559 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10560
10561
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010562timeout tunnel <timeout>
10563 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10565 yes | no | yes | yes
10566 Arguments :
10567 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10568 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10569 as explained at the top of this document.
10570
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010571 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010572 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10573 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10574 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010575 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10576 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010577 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10578 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10579 specified.
10580
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010581 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10582 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10583 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10584 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10585 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10586 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10587 state.
10588
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010589 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10590 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10591 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10592 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010594
10595 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10596 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10597 forget about it.
10598
10599 Example :
10600 defaults http
10601 option http-server-close
10602 timeout connect 5s
10603 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010604 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010605 timeout server 30s
10606 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10607
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010608 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010609
10610
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010611transparent (deprecated)
10612 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010614 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010615 Arguments : none
10616
10617 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10618 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10619 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10620 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10621 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10622 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10623 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10624 appropriate server.
10625
10626 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10627
10628 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10629 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010631 See also: "option transparent"
10632
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010633unique-id-format <string>
10634 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10636 yes | yes | yes | no
10637 Arguments :
10638 <string> is a log-format string.
10639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010640 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10641 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10642 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10643 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010644
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010645 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10646 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10647 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10648 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10649 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10650 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10651 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10652 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010653
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010654 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10655 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010656
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010657 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010658
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010659 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010660
10661 will generate:
10662
10663 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10664
10665 See also: "unique-id-header"
10666
10667unique-id-header <name>
10668 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10670 yes | yes | yes | no
10671 Arguments :
10672 <name> is the name of the header.
10673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010674 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10675 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010677 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010678
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010679 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010680 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10681
10682 will generate:
10683
10684 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10685
10686 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010687
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010688use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010689 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10691 no | yes | yes | no
10692 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010693 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10694 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010695
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010696 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10697 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010698
10699 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10700 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10701 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010702 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010703 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010704 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10705 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010706
10707 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10708 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10709 assign the backend.
10710
10711 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10712 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10713 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10714 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10715 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10716 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10717
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010718 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010719 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010720 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10721 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10722 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10723
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010724 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10725 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10726 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10727 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10728 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10729 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10730 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10731 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10732 cannot be forced from the request.
10733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010734 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010735 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10736 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10737
10738 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10739 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010740
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010741
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010742use-server <server> if <condition>
10743use-server <server> unless <condition>
10744 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10746 no | no | yes | yes
10747 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010748 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010749
10750 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10751
10752 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10753 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10754 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10755
10756 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10757 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10758 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10759 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10760 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10761 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10762 matches will assign the server.
10763
10764 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10765 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10766 with the next rules until one matches.
10767
10768 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10769 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10770 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10771 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10772
10773 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10774 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10775 stripped.
10776
10777 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10778 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10779 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10780 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10781
10782 Example :
10783 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10784 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10785 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10786 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10787 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10788 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010789 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010790 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10791 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10792
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010793 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107965. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010797--------------------------
10798
10799The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10800depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10801settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10802written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10803described in this section.
10804
10805
108065.1. Bind options
10807-----------------
10808
10809The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10810as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10811no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10812parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10813while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10814provided immediately after the setting name.
10815
10816The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10817
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010818accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10819 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10820 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10821 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10822 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10823 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10824 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10825 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10826 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10827 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010828 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10829 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10830 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010832accept-proxy
10833 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010834 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10835 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010836 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10837 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10838 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10839 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010840 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010841 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10842 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010843 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10844 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010846allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010847 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010848 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10849 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10850 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10851 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010852
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010853alpn <protocols>
10854 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10855 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10856 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10857 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10858 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010859 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10860 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10861 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10862 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10863 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10864 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10865 preference, like below :
10866
10867 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010869backlog <backlog>
10870 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10871 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10872
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010873curves <curves>
10874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10875 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10876 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10877 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10878 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10879 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10880
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010881ecdhe <named curve>
10882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010883 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10884 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010885
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010886ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10888 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10889 client's certificate.
10890
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010891ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10893 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10894 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10895 error is ignored.
10896
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010897ca-sign-file <cafile>
10898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10899 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10900 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10901 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10902 'generate-certificates' for details.
10903
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010904ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10906 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10907 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10908 'generate-certificates' for details.
10909
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010910ciphers <ciphers>
10911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10912 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010913 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010914 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010915 information and recommendations see e.g.
10916 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10917 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10918 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10919
10920ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10922 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10923 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10924 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010925 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10926 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010927
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010928crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10930 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10931 to verify client's certificate.
10932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010933crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10935 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10936 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10937 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10938 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10939 file.
10940
10941 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10942 are loaded.
10943
10944 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010945 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010946 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10947 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10948 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10949 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10951 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010952 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010953
10954 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10955 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10956 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10957 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010958 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10959 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010960
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010961 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010962
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010963 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010964 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010965 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10966 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010967 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10968 clients).
10969
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010970 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10971 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10972 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10973 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10974 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10975 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10976 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10977 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10978 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10979 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10980 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10981 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10982 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10983
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010984 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10985 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10986 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10987 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10988 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10989
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010990 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10991 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10992 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10993 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010994
10995 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10996 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10997 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10998 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10999 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11000 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11001 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11002 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11003 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11004
11005 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11006
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011007 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011008 a cert bundle.
11009
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011011 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11012 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11013 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11014 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11015 provide multi-cert support.
11016
11017 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11018
11019 Filename | CN | SAN
11020 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11021 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011022 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011023 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11024 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11025
11026 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11027 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11028 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11029 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011030 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11031 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11032 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011033
11034 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11035 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11036
11037 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11038 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11039 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11040
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011041crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011043 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011044 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011045 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011046
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011047crt-list <file>
11048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011049 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11050 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011051
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011052 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11053
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011054 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11055 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011056 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011057 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011058
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011059 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11060 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11061 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11062 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11063 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11064 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11065 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11066 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011067
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011068 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011069 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011070 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11071 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11072 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011073
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011074 crt-list file example:
11075 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011076 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011077 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011078 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011080defer-accept
11081 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11082 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11083 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011085 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11086 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11087 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11088 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11089 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11090 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11091 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11092
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011093expose-fd listeners
11094 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11095 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011096 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11097 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011098 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011099
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011100force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011101 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011102 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011103 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011104 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011105
11106force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011107 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011108 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011109 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011110
11111force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011112 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011113 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011114 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011115
11116force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011117 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011118 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011119 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011120
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011121force-tlsv13
11122 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11123 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011124 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011125
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011126generate-certificates
11127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11128 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11129 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11130 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11131 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11132 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11133 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11134 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11135 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11136 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11137 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11138
11139 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11140 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011141 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011142 certificate is used many times.
11143
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011144gid <gid>
11145 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11146 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11147 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11148 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11149 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11150
11151group <group>
11152 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11153 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11154 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11155 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11156 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11157
11158id <id>
11159 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11160 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11161 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11162 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11163
11164interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011165 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11166 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11167 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11168 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11169 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11170 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011171 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11172 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11173 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11174 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11175 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11176 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011177
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011178level <level>
11179 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11180 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11181 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011183 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11184 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11185 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011186 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011187 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011188 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011189 all counters).
11190
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011191severity-output <format>
11192 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11193 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11194 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11195 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11196 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11197 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11198 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11199 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11200 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11201 rfc5424 convention.
11202
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011203maxconn <maxconn>
11204 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11205 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11206 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11207 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11208 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11209 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11210 eat all memory.
11211
11212mode <mode>
11213 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11214 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11215 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11216 UNIX sockets.
11217
11218mss <maxseg>
11219 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11220 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11221 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11222 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11223 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11224 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11225 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11226 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11227 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11228 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11229 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11230
11231name <name>
11232 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11233 page.
11234
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011235namespace <name>
11236 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11237 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11238 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11239 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11240
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011241nice <nice>
11242 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11243 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11244 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11245 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11246 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11247 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11248 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11249 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11250 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11251 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11252 one for an RDP socket.
11253
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011254no-ca-names
11255 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11256 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11257
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011258no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011260 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011261 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011262 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011263 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11264 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011265
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011266no-tls-tickets
11267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11268 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11269 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011270 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11271 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011273no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011275 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011276 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011277 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011278 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11279 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011281no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011283 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011284 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011285 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011286 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11287 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011288
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011289no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011291 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011292 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011293 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011294 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11295 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011296
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011297no-tlsv13
11298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11299 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11300 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11301 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011302 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11303 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011304
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011305npn <protocols>
11306 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11307 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11308 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11309 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011310 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011311 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11312 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11313 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11314 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11315 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011316
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011317prefer-client-ciphers
11318 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11319 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11320 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011321 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11322 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11323 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011324
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011325process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11326 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11327 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011328 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011329 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11330 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11331 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11332 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011333 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011334 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11335 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11336 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11337
11338 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11339
11340 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11341 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11342 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11343 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11344 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11345 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11346 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11347 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011348
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011349proto <name>
11350 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11351 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11352 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11353 in haproxy -vv.
11354 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11355 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011356 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011357 h2" on the bind line.
11358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359ssl
11360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011361 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011362 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11363 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011364 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11365 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011366
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011367ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11368 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11369 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11370 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11371
11372ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11373 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11374 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11375 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11376
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011377strict-sni
11378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11379 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11380 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11381 See the "crt" option for more information.
11382
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011383tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011384 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011385 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11386 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011387 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011388 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11389 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11390 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11391 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11392 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11393 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11394 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11395
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011396tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011397 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011398 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11399 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11400 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11401 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11402 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11403 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11404 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011405 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11406 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11407 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011408
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011409tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11410 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011411 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11412 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11413 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11414 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11415 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11416 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11417 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11418 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11419 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11420 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011421 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11422 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011424transparent
11425 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11426 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11427 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11428 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11429 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11430 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11431 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11432 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11433 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11434 so check for support with your vendor.
11435
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011436v4v6
11437 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11438 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11439 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11440 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011441 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011442
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011443v6only
11444 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11445 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11446 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011447 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11448 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011450uid <uid>
11451 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11452 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11453 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11454 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11455 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11456
11457user <user>
11458 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11459 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11460 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11461 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11462 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11463
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011464verify [none|optional|required]
11465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11466 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11467 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11468 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11469 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011470 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11471 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11472 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11473 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114755.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011476------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011478The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11479which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11480arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11481settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11482after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11483Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11484address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011486 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011487 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011488
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011489Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11490keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011492The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011493
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011494addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011495 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011496 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11497 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11498 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11499 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11500 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011501
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011502agent-check
11503 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011504 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011505 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11506 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11507 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011509 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011510 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011511 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11512 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11513 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011514
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011515 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11516 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11517 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11518 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11519 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011520
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011521 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011523
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011524 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11525 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11526 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011528 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11529 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11530 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011531
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011532 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11533 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11534 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11535 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11536 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011537 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011538 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011539
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011540 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11541 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011542
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011543 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11544 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11545 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11546 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11547 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11548 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11549 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11550 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11551 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011552
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011553 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11554 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011555 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11556 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11557 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011558 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011559
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011560 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011561 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011562
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011563agent-send <string>
11564 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11565 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11566 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11567 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11568 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11569
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011570agent-inter <delay>
11571 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11572 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11573
11574 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11575 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11576 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11577 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11578 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11579 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11580 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11581 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11582 of backends use the same servers.
11583
11584 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11585
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011586agent-addr <addr>
11587 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11588
11589 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11590 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11591 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11592 hostname, it will be resolved.
11593
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011594agent-port <port>
11595 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11596
11597 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11598
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011599alpn <protocols>
11600 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11601 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11602 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11603 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11604 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11605 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11606 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11607 now obsolete NPN extension.
11608 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11609 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11610
11611 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011613backup
11614 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11615 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11616 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11617 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011618 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11619 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011620
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011621ca-file <cafile>
11622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11623 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11624 server's certificate.
11625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011626check
11627 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011628 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11629 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11630 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11631 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11632 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11633 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11634 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011635 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11636 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011637 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11638 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011639
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011640check-send-proxy
11641 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11642 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11643 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11644 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11645 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11646 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11647 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11648
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011649check-alpn <protocols>
11650 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11651 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11652 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11653
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011654check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011655 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011656 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11657 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011658
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011659check-ssl
11660 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11661 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11662 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11663 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011664 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011665 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11666 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011668 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11669 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011670
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011671ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11673 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11674 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011675 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11676 information and recommendations see e.g.
11677 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11678 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11679 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011680
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011681ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11683 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11684 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11685 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011686 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11687 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11688 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011690cookie <value>
11691 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11692 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11693 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11694 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11695 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11696 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11697 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11698
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011699crl-file <crlfile>
11700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11701 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11702 to verify server's certificate.
11703
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011704crt <cert>
11705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11706 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11707 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11708 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11709 certificate request.
11710
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011711disabled
11712 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11713 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11714 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11715 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11716 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011717 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011718
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011719enabled
11720 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11721 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11722 default value.
11723 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11724 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011726error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011727 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11728 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11729 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011731 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011733fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11735 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11736 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11737
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011738force-sslv3
11739 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11740 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011741 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011742 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011743
11744force-tlsv10
11745 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011746 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011747 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011748
11749force-tlsv11
11750 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011751 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011752 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011753
11754force-tlsv12
11755 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011756 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011757 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011758
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011759force-tlsv13
11760 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11761 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011762 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011764id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011765 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11766 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11767 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011768
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011769init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11770 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11771 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011772 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011773 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11774 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11775 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11776 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11777 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11778 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11779 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11780 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11781 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011782 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011783 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11784 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11785 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11786 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11787 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11788 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011789 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011790
11791 Example:
11792 defaults
11793 # never fail on address resolution
11794 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011796inter <delay>
11797fastinter <delay>
11798downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011799 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11800 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11801 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11802 between checks depending on the server state :
11803
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011804 Server state | Interval used
11805 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11806 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11807 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11808 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11809 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11810 or yet unchecked. |
11811 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11812 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11813 | "inter" otherwise.
11814 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011816 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11817 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11818 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11819 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011820 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11821 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11822 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11823 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11824 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011826maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011827 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11828 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11829 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11830 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11831 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11832 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11833 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11834 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011836maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011837 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11838 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11839 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11840 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11841 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11842 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11843 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11844
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011845max-reuse <count>
11846 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11847 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11848 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11849 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11850 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11851 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11852 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11853 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011855minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011856 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11857 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11858 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11859 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11860 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11861 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011862 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011864
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011865namespace <name>
11866 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11867 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11868 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11869 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11870
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011871no-agent-check
11872 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11873 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11874 default value.
11875 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11876 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11877
11878no-backup
11879 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11880 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11881 default value.
11882 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11883 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11884
11885no-check
11886 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11887 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11888 default value.
11889 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11890 "default-server" "check" setting.
11891
11892no-check-ssl
11893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11895 default value.
11896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11897 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11898
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011899no-send-proxy
11900 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11901 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11902 default value.
11903 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11904 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11905
11906no-send-proxy-v2
11907 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11908 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11909 default value.
11910 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11911 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11912
11913no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11914 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11915 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11916 default value.
11917 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11918 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11919
11920no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11921 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11922 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11923 default value.
11924 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11925 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11926
11927no-ssl
11928 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11929 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11930 default value.
11931 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11932 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11933
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011934no-ssl-reuse
11935 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11936 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11937 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11938 and for paranoid users.
11939
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011940no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011941 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11942 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011943 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011944
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011945 Supported in default-server: No
11946
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011947no-tls-tickets
11948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11949 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11950 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011951 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11952 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011953 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011955no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011956 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011957 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11958 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011959 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11960 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011961 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011962
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011963 Supported in default-server: No
11964
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011965no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011966 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011967 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11968 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011969 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11970 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011971 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011972
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011973 Supported in default-server: No
11974
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011975no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011976 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011977 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11978 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011979 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11980 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011981 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011982
11983 Supported in default-server: No
11984
11985no-tlsv13
11986 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11987 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11988 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11989 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11990 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011991 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011992
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011993 Supported in default-server: No
11994
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011995no-verifyhost
11996 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11997 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11998 default value.
11999 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12000 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012001
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012002non-stick
12003 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12004 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12005 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12006
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012007npn <protocols>
12008 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12009 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12010 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12011 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12012 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12013 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12014 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012016observe <mode>
12017 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12018 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12019 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12020 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12021 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12022 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012023 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012024
12025 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012027on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012028 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12029 Currently, four modes are available:
12030 - fastinter: force fastinter
12031 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12032 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12033 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12034 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12035
12036 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12037
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012038on-marked-down <action>
12039 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12040 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012041 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12042 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12043 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12044 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12045 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12046 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12047 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12048 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012049
12050 Actions are disabled by default
12051
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012052on-marked-up <action>
12053 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12054 Currently one action is available:
12055 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12056 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12057 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12058 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12060 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012061 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12062 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12063
12064 Actions are disabled by default
12065
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012066pool-max-conn <max>
12067 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12068 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12069 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12070 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12071 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12072 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12073
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012074pool-purge-delay <delay>
12075 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12076 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12077 1s.
12078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012079port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012080 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12081 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12082 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12083 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12084 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12085 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12086
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012087proto <name>
12088
12089 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12090 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12091 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12092 reported in haproxy -vv.
12093 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12094 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012096redir <prefix>
12097 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12098 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12099 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12100 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12101 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12102 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12103 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12104 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012105 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012106 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12108 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12109 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12110 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12111
12112 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012114rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012115 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12116 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12117 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12118
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012119resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12120 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12121 server.
12122
12123 Available options:
12124
12125 * allow-dup-ip
12126 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12127 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12128 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12129 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12130 For such case, simply enable this option.
12131 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12132
12133 * prevent-dup-ip
12134 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12135 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12136 same fqdn.
12137 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12138
12139 Example:
12140 backend b_myapp
12141 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12142 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12143 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12144
12145 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12146 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12147 it
12148 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12149 different address
12150
12151 Default value: not set
12152
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012153resolve-prefer <family>
12154 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12155 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12156 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12157 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12158
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012159 Default value: ipv6
12160
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012161 Example:
12162
12163 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012164
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012165resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12166 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12167 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012168 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012169 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12170 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012171 configured network, another address is selected.
12172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012173 Example:
12174
12175 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012176
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012177resolvers <id>
12178 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12179 hostname.
12180
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012181 Example:
12182
12183 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012184
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012185 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012186
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012187send-proxy
12188 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12189 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12190 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12191 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012192 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12193 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12194 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12195 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12196 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12197 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12198 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12199 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12200 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12201 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012202 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12203 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012204
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012205send-proxy-v2
12206 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12207 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12208 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12209 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012210 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12211 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12212 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12213 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012214
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012215proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12216 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12217 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012218 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12219 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012220 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12221 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012222 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012223
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012224send-proxy-v2-ssl
12225 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12226 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12229 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12230 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12231 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012232 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12233 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012234
12235send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12236 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12237 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12238 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12239 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12240 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12241 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12242 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12243 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012244 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12245 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012247slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012248 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12249 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12250 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12251 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12252 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12253 parameters :
12254
12255 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12256 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12257
12258 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12259 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12260 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12261 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12262
12263 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12264 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12265 seen as failed.
12266
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012267sni <expression>
12268 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12269 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12270 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12271 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012272 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12273 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012274 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012275 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12276 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012277
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012278source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012279source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012280source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012281 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12282 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12283 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12284 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12285
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012286 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12287 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12288 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12289 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12290 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12291 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12292 server.
12293
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012294 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12295 specifying the source address without port(s).
12296
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012297ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012298 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12299 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12300 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12301 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12302 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12303 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012304 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12305 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012306
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012307ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12308 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12309 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12310 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12311
12312ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12313 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12314 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12315 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12316
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012317ssl-reuse
12318 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12319 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12320 default value.
12321 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12322 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12323
12324stick
12325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12327 default value.
12328 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12329 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012330
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012331tcp-ut <delay>
12332 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12333 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12334 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012335 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012336 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12337 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12338 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12339 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12340 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12341 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12342 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12343 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12344 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012346track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012347 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12348 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12349 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12350 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012351 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12352
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012353tls-tickets
12354 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12355 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12356 default value.
12357 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12358 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012359
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012360verify [none|required]
12361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012362 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012363 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12364 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012365 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012366 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12367 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12368 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12369 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12370 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12371 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12372 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12373 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012374
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012375verifyhost <hostname>
12376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012377 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12378 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12379 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12380 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12381 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12382 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12383 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12384 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012386weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012387 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12388 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12389 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012390 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12391 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12392 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12393 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12394 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12395 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012396
12397
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123985.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12399-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012400
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012401HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12402using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12403configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012404This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12405can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12406workload.
12407This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12408resolution at run time.
12409Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12410carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12411
12412
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124135.3.1. Global overview
12414----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012415
12416As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12417different steps of the process life:
12418
12419 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12420 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12421 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12422
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012423 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12424 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012425
12426A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12427 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12428 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12429 resolution to know this new IP.
12430
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012431When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012432HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012433SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12434from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12435will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12436will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012437
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012438A few things important to notice:
12439 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12440 first valid response.
12441
12442 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12443 servers return an error.
12444
12445
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124465.3.2. The resolvers section
12447----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012448
12449This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012450HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12451contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012452
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012453When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12454uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12455is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12456answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12457
12458When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012459used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012460
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012461 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12462 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12463 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012464
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012465 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12466 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012467
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012468 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12469 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12470 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012471
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012472For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12473following scenarios are possible:
12474
12475 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12476 ignored
12477
12478 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12479 applied
12480
12481 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12482 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12483
12484 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12485 retries the query with a new type
12486
12487 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12488 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012489
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012490As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12491a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012492<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012493
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012494
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012495resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012496 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012497
12498A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12499
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012500accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012501 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012502 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012503 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12504 by RFC 6891)
12505
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012506 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12507
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012508nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12509 DNS server description:
12510 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12511 <ip> : IP address of the server
12512 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12513
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012514parse-resolv-conf
12515 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12516 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12517 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12518
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012519hold <status> <period>
12520 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12521 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012522 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012523 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012524 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12525 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12526 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12527
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012528 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012529
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012530resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012531 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12532 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12533 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12534
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012535resolve_retries <nb>
12536 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12537 giving up.
12538 Default value: 3
12539
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012540 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12541 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12542 type.
12543
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544timeout <event> <time>
12545 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12546 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12547 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012548 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12549 other time applied.
12550 Default value: 1s
12551 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12552 have been received.
12553 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012554 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12555 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12556
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012557 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012558
12559 resolvers mydns
12560 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12561 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012562 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012563 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012564 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012565 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012566 hold other 30s
12567 hold refused 30s
12568 hold nx 30s
12569 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012570 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012571 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012572
12573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125746. HTTP header manipulation
12575---------------------------
12576
12577In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12578response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12579request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12580which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012581against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012582
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012583If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12584to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12585but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12586HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12587stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12588because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12589a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12590still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012592This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12593in section 4.2 :
12594
12595 - reqadd <string>
12596 - reqallow <search>
12597 - reqiallow <search>
12598 - reqdel <search>
12599 - reqidel <search>
12600 - reqdeny <search>
12601 - reqideny <search>
12602 - reqpass <search>
12603 - reqipass <search>
12604 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12605 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12606 - reqtarpit <search>
12607 - reqitarpit <search>
12608 - rspadd <string>
12609 - rspdel <search>
12610 - rspidel <search>
12611 - rspdeny <search>
12612 - rspideny <search>
12613 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12614 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12615
12616With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12617is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12618parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12619prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12620Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12621
12622 \t for a tab
12623 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12624 \n for a new line (LF)
12625 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12626 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12627 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12628 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12629 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12630
12631The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12632portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12633above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12634regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126359 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12636is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12637
12638The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12639after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12640
12641Notes related to these keywords :
12642---------------------------------
12643 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12644 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12645 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12646
12647 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12648 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12649 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12650
12651 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12652 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12653 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12654 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12655 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12656
12657 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12658 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12659 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12660 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12661 useless headers before adding new ones.
12662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012663 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012664 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12665
12666 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12667 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12668 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12669
12670 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12671 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012672 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012673
12674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12676----------------------------------
12677
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012678HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12680The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12681these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12682but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12683data called patterns.
12684
12685
126867.1. ACL basics
12687---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012688
12689The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12690content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12691from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12692simple :
12693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012695 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12697 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012699The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12700adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012701
12702In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012704 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012705
12706This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12707Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12708and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012709an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12710conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12711as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12712are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012713
12714ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12715'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12716which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12717
12718There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12719performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012721The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12722specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12723this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012724methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12725ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726
12727Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12728 - boolean
12729 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12730 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12731 - string
12732 - data block
12733
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012734Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12735converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12736would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12737The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12738which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12739
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012740Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12741keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12742fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12743which are summarized in the table below :
12744
12745 +---------------------+-----------------+
12746 | Sample or converter | Default |
12747 | output type | matching method |
12748 +---------------------+-----------------+
12749 | boolean | bool |
12750 +---------------------+-----------------+
12751 | integer | int |
12752 +---------------------+-----------------+
12753 | ip | ip |
12754 +---------------------+-----------------+
12755 | string | str |
12756 +---------------------+-----------------+
12757 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12758 +---------------------+-----------------+
12759
12760Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12761matching method, see below.
12762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12764 - boolean
12765 - integer or integer range
12766 - IP address / network
12767 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12768 - regular expression
12769 - hex block
12770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012771The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12772
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012773 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12774 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012776 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012777 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012778 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012779 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12782read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12783if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12784lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12785will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12786beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12787a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12788lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12789exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12790
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012791The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12792parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12793ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12794a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12795check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12796
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012797The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12798socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12799file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12802loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12803
12804 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12805
12806In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12807the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12808case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12809as well.
12810
12811The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12812sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12813do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12814methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12815is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012816obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12818default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12819that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12820string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12821
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012822The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12823By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12824string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12825resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12826server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12827waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12828flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12829function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12832sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12833be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012834
12835 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12836 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12838 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12839 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12840 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012841
12842 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12843 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012845
12846 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012848
12849 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012852 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012853 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12854
12855 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12856 binary or string samples.
12857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12859 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12862 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12863 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12866 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12869 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12872 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12875 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012876 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12879 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12880 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012881
12882For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12883request, it is possible to do :
12884
12885 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12886
12887In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12888buffer, one would use the following acl :
12889
12890 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12891
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012892On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12893possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12894
12895 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12898criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12899method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12900to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12901criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12902the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012905the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12906For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12909 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12910 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12911 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012912
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012913
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012914The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12915types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12916combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12917brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12918default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920 +-------------------------------------------------+
12921 | Input sample type |
12922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012923 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12925 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012927 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012929 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012931 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012933 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012934 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012935 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012937 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012938 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012939 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012941 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012943 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012945 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012947 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12949 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012951
12952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129537.1.1. Matching booleans
12954------------------------
12955
12956In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12957Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12958When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12959that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12960
12961Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12962return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12963"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129667.1.2. Matching integers
12967------------------------
12968
12969Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12970enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12971to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12972
12973Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12974matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12975lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012976
12977For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12978unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12979representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12980
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012981As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12982two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12983instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12984ranges and operators.
12985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012987operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12988Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12989of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012991Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012992
12993 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12994 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12995 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12996 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12997 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012999For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013000
13001 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13002
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013003This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13004
13005 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130087.1.3. Matching strings
13009-----------------------
13010
13011String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13012different forms :
13013
13014 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013015 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016
13017 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013019
13020 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13021 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13022
13023 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13024 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13025
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013026 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13028 matches.
13029
13030 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13031 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13032 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013033
13034String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13035exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13036characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13037string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13038to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013039before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013040
13041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130427.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13043---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013044
13045Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13046they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13047possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13048passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13049the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013050the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13051match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013052
13053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130547.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13055-------------------------------------
13056
13057It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13058not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13059a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13060to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13061digits may be used upper or lower case.
13062
13063Example :
13064 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13065 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13066
13067
130687.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13069---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013070
13071IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13072netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13073within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013074host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013075difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13076at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13077does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13078parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013079
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013080The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13081abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13082
13083 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13084 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13085 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13086 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13087 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13088 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13089 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13090 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13091
13092Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13093192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13094
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013095IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13096Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13097trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13098IPv6 patterns.
13099
13100HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13101following situations :
13102 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13103 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13104 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13105 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13106 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13107 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13108 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13109 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13110 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13111 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113
131147.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13115----------------------------------
13116
13117Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13118combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13119
13120 - AND (implicit)
13121 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13122 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013128Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13129indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13132"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13133requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13134is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13135
13136 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013137 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13138 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13139 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013140
13141To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13142and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13143
13144 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13145 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13146 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13147 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13148
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013149 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13151 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13152 use_backend www if host_www
13153
13154It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13155expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13156be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13157the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13158
13159 The following rule :
13160
13161 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013162 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163
13164 Can also be written that way :
13165
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013166 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167
13168It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13169to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13170simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13171sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13172good use is the following :
13173
13174 With named ACLs :
13175
13176 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13177 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13178 monitor fail if site_dead
13179
13180 With anonymous ACLs :
13181
13182 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13183
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013184See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13185keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186
13187
131887.3. Fetching samples
13189---------------------
13190
13191Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13192against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13193sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13194ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13195of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13196available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13197
13198This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13199Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13200compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13201deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13202
13203The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13204matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13205method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13206indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13207
13208As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13209when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13210mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13211the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13212ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13213
13214Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13215multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13216when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13218are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013219is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13220all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13221
13222Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13223 - name
13224 - name(arg1)
13225 - name(arg1,arg2)
13226
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013227
132287.3.1. Converters
13229-----------------
13230
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013231Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13232of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13233is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13234was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013235has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013236unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13237
13238These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13239sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13240the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013241support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013242
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013243A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13244support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13245supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13246(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13247bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013250
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001325151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13252 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13253 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13254 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13255 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13256 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13257
13258 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013259 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13260 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013261 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13262 frontend http-in
13263 bind *:8081
13264 default_backend servers
13265 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13266 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13267
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013268add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013269 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013270 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013271 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13272 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013273 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013274 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13275 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13276 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13277 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013278 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013279 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013280
13281and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013282 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013283 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013284 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13285 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13289 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13290 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013291 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013292 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013293
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013294b64dec
13295 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13296 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13297
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013298base64
13299 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013300 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013301 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13302
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013303bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013304 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013305 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013306 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013307 presence of a flag).
13308
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013309bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13310 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13311 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013312 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013313
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013314concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13315 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13316 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13317 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13318 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13319 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13320 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13321 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13322 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13323 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13324 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13325 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13326 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13327 delimitors.
13328
13329 Example:
13330 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13331 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13332 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13333 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13334
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013335cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013336 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13337 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013338
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013339crc32([<avalanche>])
13340 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13341 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13342 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13343 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13344 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13345 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13346 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13347 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13348 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13349 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013350 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13351
13352crc32c([<avalanche>])
13353 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13354 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13355 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13356 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13357 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13358 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13359 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13360 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013361
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013362da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013363 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13364 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13365 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13366 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013367 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013368 configuration language.
13369
13370 Example:
13371 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013372 bind *:8881
13373 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013374 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013375
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013376debug
13377 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13378 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13379 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13380
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013381div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013382 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13383 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013384 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013385 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13386 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013387 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013388 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13389 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13390 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13391 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013392 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013393 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013394
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013395djb2([<avalanche>])
13396 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13397 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13398 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13399 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13400 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13401 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13402 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013403 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13404 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013405
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013406even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013407 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013408 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13409
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013410field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13411 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13412 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13413 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13414 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13415 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13416 fields.
13417
13418 Example :
13419 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13420 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13421 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13422 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13423 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013424
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013425hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013426 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013427 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013428 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013429 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013430
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013431hex2i
13432 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13433 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013435http_date([<offset>])
13436 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13437 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13438 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13439 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13440 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13441 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013443in_table(<table>)
13444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13446 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013447 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013448 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13449
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013450ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13451 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013452 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013453 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13454 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13455 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13456 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13457 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013458
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013459json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013460 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013461 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013462 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013463 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13464 of errors:
13465 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13466 bytes, ...)
13467 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13468 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13469
13470 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13471 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13472 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13473 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13474 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13475 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013476 - "ascii" : never fails;
13477 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13478 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013479 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013480 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013481 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13482 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13483
13484 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013485 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013486
13487 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013488 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013489 capture request header user-agent len 150
13490 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013491
13492 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13493 GET / HTTP/1.0
13494 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13495
13496 Output log:
13497 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013499language(<value>[,<default>])
13500 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13501 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13502 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13503 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13504 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13505 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13506 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13507 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13508 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013509 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013510 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13511 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013512
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013513 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013515 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13516 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013518 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13519 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13520 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13521 use_backend spanish if es
13522 use_backend french if fr
13523 use_backend english if en
13524 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013525
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013526length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013527 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13528 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13529 type. The result is of type integer.
13530
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013531lower
13532 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13533 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13534 type. The result is of type string.
13535
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013536ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13537 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13538 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13539 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13540 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13541 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13542 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13543
13544 Example :
13545
13546 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013547 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013548 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013550map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13551map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13552map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13553 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13554 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13555 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13556 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13557 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13558 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13559 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13560 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013561
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013562 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13563 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13564 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013565
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013566 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013567 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013569 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13571 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013573 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013575 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13577 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13579 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13581 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013583 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13585 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13587 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13589 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13590 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013591
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013592 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13593 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13594 the corresponding match text.
13595
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013596 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13597 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13598 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13599 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13600 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013601
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013602 Example :
13603
13604 # this is a comment and is ignored
13605 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13606 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13607 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13608 | | | `---------- value
13609 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13610 | `---------------------------- key
13611 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13612
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013613mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013614 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13615 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013616 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013617 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013618 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013619 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13620 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13621 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13622 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013623 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013624 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013625
13626mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013627 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013628 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13629 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013630 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013631 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013632 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013633 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13634 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13635 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13636 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013638 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013639
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013640nbsrv
13641 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13642 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13643 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13644 map lookup.
13645
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013646neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013647 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13648 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13649 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13650 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013651
13652not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013653 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013654 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013656 absence of a flag).
13657
13658odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013659 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013660 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13661
13662or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013663 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013664 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013665 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13666 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013674
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013675regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013676 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13677 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13678 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13679 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13680 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13681 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13682 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13683 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13684 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13685 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013686 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13687 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13688 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13689 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013690
13691 Example :
13692
13693 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13694 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13695 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13696 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13697
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013698capture-req(<id>)
13699 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13700 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13701
13702 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013703 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13704 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013705
13706capture-res(<id>)
13707 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13708 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13709
13710 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013711 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13712 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013713
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013714sdbm([<avalanche>])
13715 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13716 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13717 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13718 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13719 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13720 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13721 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013722 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13723 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013724
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013725set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013726 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13727 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13728 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013729 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013730 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13731 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013732 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013733 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13734 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013735 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013736 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013737
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013738sha1
13739 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13740 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13741
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013742strcmp(<var>)
13743 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13744 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13745 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13746 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13747 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13748 shorter).
13749
13750 Example :
13751
13752 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13753 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13754 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13755
13756
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013757sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013758 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13759 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013760 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013761 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13762 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013763 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013764 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13765 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013766 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013767 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13768 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013769 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013770 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013771
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013772svarint
13773 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers signed "varints" ("sint32"
13774 and "sint64") to an integer.
13775 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13776 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13777
13778varint
13779 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers "varints", excepted
13780 the signed ones "sint32" and "sint64", to an integer.
13781 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13782 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13783
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013784table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13788 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13789 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13790 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13791
13792
13793table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13797 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13798 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13799 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13800
13801table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13806 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13807
13808table_conn_cur(<table>)
13809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13812 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13813 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13814
13815table_conn_rate(<table>)
13816 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13817 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13818 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13819 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13820 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13821
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013822table_gpt0(<table>)
13823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13826 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13827 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13828
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013829table_gpc0(<table>)
13830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13832 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13833 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13834 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13835
13836table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13840 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13841 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13842 sample fetch keyword.
13843
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013844table_gpc1(<table>)
13845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13848 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13849 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13850
13851table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13855 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13856 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13857 sample fetch keyword.
13858
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013859table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013863 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13864 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13865
13866table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13869 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13870 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13871 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13872 keyword.
13873
13874table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013878 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13879 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13880
13881table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13884 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13885 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13886 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13887 keyword.
13888
13889table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013893 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13894 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13895 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13896 keyword.
13897
13898table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13899 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13900 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013902 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13903 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13904 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13905 keyword.
13906
13907table_server_id(<table>)
13908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13911 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13912 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13913 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13914
13915table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013919 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13920 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13921 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13922 keyword.
13923
13924table_sess_rate(<table>)
13925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13928 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13929 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13930 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13931 keyword.
13932
13933table_trackers(<table>)
13934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13937 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13938 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13939 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13940 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13941 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13942 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13943 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13944
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013945upper
13946 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13947 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13948 type. The result is of type string.
13949
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013950url_dec
13951 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13952 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13953
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013954unset-var(<var name>)
13955 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13956 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13957 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13958 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13959 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13960 response),
13961 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13962 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13963 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13964 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13965
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013966utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13967 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13968 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13969 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13970 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13971 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13972 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13973
13974 Example :
13975
13976 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013978 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13979
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013980word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13981 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13982 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13983 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13984 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13985 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13986
13987 Example :
13988 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13989 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13990 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13991 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13992 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013993
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013994wt6([<avalanche>])
13995 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13996 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13997 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13998 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13999 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14000 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14001 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014002 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14003 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014004
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014005xor(<value>)
14006 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014007 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014008 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014009 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014010 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014011 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14012 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014013 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014014 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14015 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014016 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014017 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014018
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014019xxh32([<seed>])
14020 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14021 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14022 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14023 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14024 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14025 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14026 as cryptographically secure.
14027
14028xxh64([<seed>])
14029 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14030 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14031 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14032 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14033 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14034 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14035 as cryptographically secure.
14036
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014037
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140387.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014039--------------------------------------------
14040
14041A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14042not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14043"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14044The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14045
14046always_false : boolean
14047 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14048 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14049
14050always_true : boolean
14051 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14052 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14053
14054avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014055 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14057 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14058 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14059 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14060 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14061 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14062 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14063 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14064 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14065 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14066 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14067 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14068 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014071 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14072 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14073 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14074 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014075 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14076
14077be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14078 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14079 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14080 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14081 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14082 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014083 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14084 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014085
14086 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14087 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14088 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14091 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14092 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14093 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014094 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14096 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014097
14098 Example :
14099 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14100 backend dynamic
14101 mode http
14102 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14103 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014105bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014106 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14107 of the string.
14108
14109bool(<bool>) : bool
14110 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14111 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014113connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014115 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14117 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014118
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014119 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014120 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014121 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14122
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014123 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14124 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014125
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014126 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014127 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014129 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014131 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014132 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014133
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014134 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14135 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014137 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014138
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014139cpu_calls : integer
14140 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14141 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14142 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14143 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14144 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14145 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14146
14147cpu_ns_avg : integer
14148 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14149 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14150 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14151 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14152 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14153 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14154 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14155 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14156 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14157 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14158 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14159
14160cpu_ns_tot : integer
14161 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14162 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14163 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14164 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14165 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14166 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14167 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14168 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14169 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14170 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14171 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14172 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14173 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14174
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014175date([<offset>]) : integer
14176 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14177 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14178 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14179 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014180 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14181
14182 Example :
14183
14184 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14185 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014186
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014187date_us : integer
14188 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14189 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14190 from the same timeval structure.
14191
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014192distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14193 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14194 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14195 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14196 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14197 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14198 list of supported tokens.
14199
14200distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14201 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14202 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14203 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14204 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14205 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14206 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14207 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14208 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14209 supported tokens.
14210
14211 Example :
14212 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14213 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14214 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14215 # send large files to the big farm
14216 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14217
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014218env(<name>) : string
14219 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14220 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14221 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14222 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14223 certain way.
14224
14225 Examples :
14226 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14227 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14228
14229 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14230 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014232fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14233 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014234 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14235 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14237 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014238 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14240 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014241
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014242fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14243 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14244 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14245 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14249 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14250 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14251 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14252 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14253 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14254 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14255 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014256
14257 Example :
14258 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14259 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14260 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14261 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14262 frontend mail
14263 bind :25
14264 mode tcp
14265 maxconn 100
14266 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14267 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14268 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14269 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014270
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014271hostname : string
14272 Returns the system hostname.
14273
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014274int(<integer>) : signed integer
14275 Returns a signed integer.
14276
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014277ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14278 Returns an ipv4.
14279
14280ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14281 Returns an ipv6.
14282
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014283lat_ns_avg : integer
14284 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14285 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14286 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14287 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14288 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14289 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14290 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14291 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14292 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14293 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14294 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14295 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14296 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14297 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14298
14299lat_ns_tot : integer
14300 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14301 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14302 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14303 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14304 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14305 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14306 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14307 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14308 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14309 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14310 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14311 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14312 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14313 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14314 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14315 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14316 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14317 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14318 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14319
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014320meth(<method>) : method
14321 Returns a method.
14322
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014323nbproc : integer
14324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14325 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14326 and debugging purposes.
14327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14330 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14331 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014332 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14333 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14334 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014335
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014336prio_class : integer
14337 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14338 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14339 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14340
14341prio_offset : integer
14342 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14343 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14344 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14345 set-priority-offset".
14346
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014347proc : integer
14348 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14349 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14350 debugging purposes.
14351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014353 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14354 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14355 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14357 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14358 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14359 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14360 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14361
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014362rand([<range>]) : integer
14363 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14364 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14365 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14366 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14367 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14371 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14372 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14373 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14374 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014375 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14376 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14377
14378srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14380 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14381 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14382 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14383 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14384 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14385 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14386
14387 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14388 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389
14390srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14391 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14392 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14393 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014394 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14396 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14397 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14398
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014399srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14401 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14402 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14403 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14404 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14405 fetch methods.
14406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14408 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14409 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014410 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14412 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014413 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414 overloading servers).
14415
14416 Example :
14417 # Redirect to a separate back
14418 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14419 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14420 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14421
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014422stopping : boolean
14423 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14424 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14425 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14426
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014427str(<string>) : string
14428 Returns a string.
14429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14431 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14432 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14433
14434table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14435 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14436 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14437 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14438
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014439thread : integer
14440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14441 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14442 and debugging purposes.
14443
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014444var(<var-name>) : undefined
14445 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014446 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14447 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014448 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014449 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14450 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014451 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014452 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14453 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014454 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014455 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144577.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458----------------------------------
14459
14460The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14461closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14462methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14463sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14464TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014465the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14466counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014467"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14468used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14469can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14470Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14471table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14472tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14473currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014475bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014476 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14477 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14478 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480be_id : integer
14481 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14482 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14483
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014484be_name : string
14485 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14486 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488dst : ip
14489 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14490 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14491 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14492 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014493 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14494 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14495 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14496 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14497 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14498 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499
14500dst_conn : integer
14501 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14502 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14503 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14504 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14505 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14506 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14507 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14508 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014509
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014510dst_is_local : boolean
14511 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14512 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14513 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14514 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014515 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014516 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14517 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14518 it only once per connection.
14519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520dst_port : integer
14521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14522 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14523 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14524 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14525 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14526 an HTTP header.
14527
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014528fc_http_major : integer
14529 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14530 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14531 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14532
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014533fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14534 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14535 header.
14536
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014537fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14538 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14539 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14540 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14541 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14542 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14543 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14544
14545fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14546 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14547 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14548 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14549 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14550 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14551 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14552
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014553fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14554 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14555 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14556 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14557 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14558
14559fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14560 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14561 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14562 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14563 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
14565fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14566 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14567 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14568 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14569 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14570
14571fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14572 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14573 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14574 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14575 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14576
14577fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14578 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14579 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14580 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14581 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14582
14583fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14584 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14585 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14586 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14587 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14588
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014589fe_defbe : string
14590 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14591 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593fe_id : integer
14594 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014595 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14597
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014598fe_name : string
14599 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14600 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14601 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014603sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014604sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14605sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14606sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014607 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14608 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14609 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014611sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014612sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14613sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14614sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014615 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14616 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14617 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014619sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014620sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14621sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14622sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014623 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14624 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014625 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14626 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14627 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014628
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014629 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014630 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14631 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014632 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14633 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14634 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014635 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14636 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14637
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014638sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14639sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14640sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14641sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14642 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14643 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14644 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14645 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14646 when a first ACL was verified.
14647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014648sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014649sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14650sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14651sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014652 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014653 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14654
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014655sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014656sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14657sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14658sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014659 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14660 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14661 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14662
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014663sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014664sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14665sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14666sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014667 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14668 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14669 See also src_conn_rate.
14670
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014671sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014672sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14673sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14674sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014675 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014676 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014677
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014678sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14679sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14680sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14681sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14682 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14683 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14684
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014685sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14686sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14687sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14688sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14689 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14690 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014692sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014693sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14694sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14695sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014696 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14697 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14698 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014699 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14700 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14701 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014702
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014703sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14704sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14705sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14706sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14707 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14708 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14709 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14710 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14711 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14712 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014714sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014715sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14716sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14717sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014718 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014719 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14720 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014722sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014723sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14724sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14725sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014726 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14727 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14728 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14729 src_http_err_rate.
14730
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014731sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014732sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14733sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14734sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014735 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014736 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14737 src_http_req_cnt.
14738
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014739sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014740sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14741sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14742sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014743 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14744 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14745 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14746 src_http_req_rate.
14747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014748sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014749sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14750sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14751sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014752 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014753 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14754 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14755 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14756 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014758 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014759 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14760 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014761 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014763sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14764sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14765sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14766sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14767 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14768 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14769 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14770 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14771 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014773sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014774sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14775sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14776sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014777 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14778 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14779 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014781sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014782sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14783sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14784sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014785 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14786 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14787 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014788
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014789sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014790sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14791sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14792sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014793 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014794 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14795 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14796 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014797 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014798 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014800sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014801sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14802sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14803sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014804 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14805 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14806 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14807 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14808 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014809 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014811sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014812sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14813sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14814sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014815 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14816 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14817 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014819sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014820sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14821sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14822sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014823 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14824 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014825 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014826 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14827 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14829 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14830 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832so_id : integer
14833 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14834 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14835 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014838 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14840 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14841 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014842 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14843 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14844 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014845 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14846 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14847 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14848 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14849 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14850 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14851 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014852
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014853 Example:
14854 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14855 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14858 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14859 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14860 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014861 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14864 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14865 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014866 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014867 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14870 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14871 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14872 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14873 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14874 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14875 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014876
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014877 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014878 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14879 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14880 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14881 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014882 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014883 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14884 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14885
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014886src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14887 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14888 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14889 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14890 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14891 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14892 was verified.
14893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014897 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014898 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014901 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14903 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014904 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14907 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14908 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14909 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014910 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014915 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014916 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014918src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14919 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14920 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14921 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14922 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14923
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014924src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14925 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14926 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14927 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14928 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014931 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014933 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14934 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014935 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14936 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14937 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014938
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014939src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14940 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14941 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14942 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14943 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14944 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14945 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14946 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014949 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014951 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014952 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14956 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14957 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14958 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14959 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014963 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14965 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014966 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14969 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14970 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14971 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014973 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14976 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14977 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14978 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014979 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14981 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014982
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014983 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014984 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014985 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014986 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014987
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014988src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14989 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14990 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14991 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14992 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14993 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14994 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14995
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014996src_is_local : boolean
14997 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14998 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14999 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15000 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015001 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015002 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15003 once per connection.
15004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015006 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15007 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15008 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15009 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15010 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015013 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15014 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15015 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15016 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15017 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019src_port : integer
15020 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15021 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15022 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15023 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015026 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015027 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15028 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15029 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015030 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015032src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15033 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15034 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15035 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15036 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015037 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15040 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15041 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15042 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15043 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15044 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15045 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15046 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15047 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015048
15049 Example :
15050 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15051 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15052 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15053 listen ssh
15054 bind :22
15055 mode tcp
15056 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015057 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015059 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061srv_id : integer
15062 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15063 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15064 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015065
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150667.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15070closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15071when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15072usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015073future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015074
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001507551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15076 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15077 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15078 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15079 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15080 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15081
15082 Example :
15083 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15084 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15085 # the request.
15086 frontend http-in
15087 bind *:8081
15088 default_backend servers
15089 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15090 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15091
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015092ssl_bc : boolean
15093 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15094 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15095 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15096
15097ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15098 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15099 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15100
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015101ssl_bc_alpn : string
15102 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15103 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15104 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15105 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15106 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15107 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15108 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15109 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15110 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15111
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015112ssl_bc_cipher : string
15113 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15114 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15115
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015116ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15117 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15118 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15119 session or a TLS ticket.
15120
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015121ssl_bc_npn : string
15122 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15123 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15124 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15125 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15126 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15127 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15128 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15129 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15130
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015131ssl_bc_protocol : string
15132 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15133 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15134
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015135ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015136 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015137 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15138 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015139
15140ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15141 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15142 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15143 if session was reused or not.
15144
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015145ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15146 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15147 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15148 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15149 BoringSSL.
15150
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015151ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15152 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15153 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015155ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15156 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15157 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15158 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15159 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15160 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15163 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15164 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15165 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15166 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015167
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015168ssl_c_der : binary
15169 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15170 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15171 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173ssl_c_err : integer
15174 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15175 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15176 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15177 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15178 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15181 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15182 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15183 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15184 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15185 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15186 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15187 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15188 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190ssl_c_key_alg : string
15191 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15192 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15193 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195ssl_c_notafter : string
15196 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15197 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15198 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_c_notbefore : string
15201 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15202 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15203 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15206 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15207 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15208 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15209 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15210 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15211 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15212 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15213 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215ssl_c_serial : binary
15216 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15217 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15218 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015220ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15221 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15222 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15223 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015224 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15225 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15226
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015227 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015228 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15231 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15232 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15233 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_c_used : boolean
15236 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15237 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239ssl_c_verify : integer
15240 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15241 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15242 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15243 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_c_version : integer
15246 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15247 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015248
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015249ssl_f_der : binary
15250 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15251 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15252 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15255 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15256 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15257 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15258 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015259 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15261 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15262 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264ssl_f_key_alg : string
15265 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15266 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15267 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269ssl_f_notafter : string
15270 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15271 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15272 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274ssl_f_notbefore : string
15275 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15276 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15277 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15280 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15281 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15282 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15283 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15284 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15285 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15286 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15287 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289ssl_f_serial : binary
15290 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15291 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15292 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015293
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015294ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15295 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15296 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15297 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15300 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15301 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15302 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304ssl_f_version : integer
15305 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15306 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15307
15308ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015309 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15310 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15311 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313 Example :
15314 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15315 listen http-https
15316 bind :80
15317 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15318 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15319
15320ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15321 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15322 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15323
15324ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015325 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15327 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15328 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15329 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15330 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15331 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15332 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15333 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335ssl_fc_cipher : string
15336 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15337 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015338
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015339ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15340 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15341 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015342 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015343
15344ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15345 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15346 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015347 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015348
15349ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15350 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15351 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15352 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015354 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015355
15356ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15357 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15358 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015359 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015362 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15363 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015364 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15365 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15366 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15367 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015368
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015369ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15370 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15371 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15372 wait until the handshake happened.
15373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15375 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015376 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15377 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15378 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15379 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015380
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015381ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015382 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015383 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15384 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015387 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15389 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15390 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15391 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15392 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15393 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15394 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396ssl_fc_protocol : string
15397 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15398 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015399
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015400ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015401 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015402 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15403 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15406 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15407 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15408 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15409 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015410
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015411ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15412 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15414 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15415 BoringSSL.
15416
15417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418ssl_fc_sni : string
15419 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15420 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15421 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15422 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15423 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15424
15425 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15426 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15427 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015428 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15429 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15433 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15436 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15437 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015438
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15444sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15445only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15446For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15447be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15448can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15449sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15450for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15451content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015454 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15456 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15459 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015460 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015462
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015463req.hdrs : string
15464 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15465 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15466 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15467 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15468
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015469req.hdrs_bin : binary
15470 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15471 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15472 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15473 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15474 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15475 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15476
15477 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15478
15479 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15480 str: <int:length><bytes>
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482req.len : integer
15483req_len : integer (deprecated)
15484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15485 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15486 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15487 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15488 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15489 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15490 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15491 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15494 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015495 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15496 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15497 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15498 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500 ACL alternatives :
15501 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15504 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15505 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15506 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15507 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 ACL alternatives :
15510 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514req.proto_http : boolean
15515req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15516 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15517 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15518 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15519 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15520 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15521 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15522 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524 Example:
15525 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15526 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15527 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015528 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15531rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15532 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15533 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15534 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15535 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15536 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15537 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15538 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15541 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15542 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15543 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15544 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15545 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 ACL derivatives :
15548 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550 Example :
15551 listen tse-farm
15552 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15553 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15554 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15555 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15556 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15557 persist rdp-cookie
15558 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15559 # This is only useful makes sense if
15560 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15561 stick-table type string size 204800
15562 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15563 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15564 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15567 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15570rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15571 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15572 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15573 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15574 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576 ACL derivatives :
15577 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015578
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015579req.ssl_alpn : string
15580 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15581 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15582 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15583 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15584 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15585 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015586 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015587
15588 Examples :
15589 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15590 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15591 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015592 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015593 default_backend bk_default
15594
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015595req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15596 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15597 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015598 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15599 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15600 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15601 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15602 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15605req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15606 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15607 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15608 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15609 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15610 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15611 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15612 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614req.ssl_sni : string
15615req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15616 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15617 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15618 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15619 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15620 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15621 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15622 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15623 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15624 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15625 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15626 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15627 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 ACL derivatives :
15630 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 Examples :
15633 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15634 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15635 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15636 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15637 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015638
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015639req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15640 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15641 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15642 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15643 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15644 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15645 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15646 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15647 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15648 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650req.ssl_ver : integer
15651req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15652 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15653 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15654 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15655 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15656 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15657 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15658 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015659 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 ACL derivatives :
15663 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015664
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015665res.len : integer
15666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15667 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15668 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15669 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15670 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15671 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15672 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15673 content inspection.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15676 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015677 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15678 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15679 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15680 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15683 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15684 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15685 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15686 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015689
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015690res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15691rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15692 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15693 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15694 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15695 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15696 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15697 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15698 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700wait_end : boolean
15701 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15702 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015703 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15705 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015706 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15708 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 Examples :
15711 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15712 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15713 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15716 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15717 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15718 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15719 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15720 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15721 tcp-request content reject
15722
15723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157247.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725--------------------------------------
15726
15727It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15728This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15729data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15730its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15731HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15732content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15733to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15734more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15735response are indexed.
15736
15737base : string
15738 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15739 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15740 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15741 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15742 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15743 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15744 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15745 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15746
15747 ACL derivatives :
15748 base : exact string match
15749 base_beg : prefix match
15750 base_dir : subdir match
15751 base_dom : domain match
15752 base_end : suffix match
15753 base_len : length match
15754 base_reg : regex match
15755 base_sub : substring match
15756
15757base32 : integer
15758 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15759 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15760 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015761 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15762 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15763 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764
15765base32+src : binary
15766 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15767 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15768 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15769 per-URL counters.
15770
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015771capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15772 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15773 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15774 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15775
15776capture.req.method : string
15777 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15778 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15779 because it's allocated.
15780
15781capture.req.uri : string
15782 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15783 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15784 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15785 allocated.
15786
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015787capture.req.ver : string
15788 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15789 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15790 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15791
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015792capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15793 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15794 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15795 The first entry is an index of 0.
15796 See also: "capture response header"
15797
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015798capture.res.ver : string
15799 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15800 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15801 persistent flag.
15802
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015803req.body : binary
15804 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15805 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15806 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15807 the first chunk is analyzed.
15808
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015809req.body_param([<name>) : string
15810 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15811 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15812 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15813 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15814 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15815 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15816 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15817 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15818 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15819 given.
15820
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015821req.body_len : integer
15822 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15823 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15824 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15825 "option http-buffer-request".
15826
15827req.body_size : integer
15828 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15829 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15830 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15831 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15832 "option http-buffer-request".
15833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834req.cook([<name>]) : string
15835cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15836 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15837 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15838 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15839 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15840 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15841 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15842 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15843 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15844
15845 ACL derivatives :
15846 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15847 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15848 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15849 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15850 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15851 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15852 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15853 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15856cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15857 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15858 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15861cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15862 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15863 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15864 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15865 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15868 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15869 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15870 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15871 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015872 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15874 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15875 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15876 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15879 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15880 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15881 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15882 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015883 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15886 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15887 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15888 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15889 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15890 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15891 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15892 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15893 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15896 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15897 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15898 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15899 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15902 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15903 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15904 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15905 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15906 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15907 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15908 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15909 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015910 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015912 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 ACL derivatives :
15915 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15916 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15917 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15918 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15919 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15920 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15921 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15922 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15923
15924req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15925hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15926 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15927 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15928 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15929 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15930 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15931 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15932 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15933 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15934 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15935
15936req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15937hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15938 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15939 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15940 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15941 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15942 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15945 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15946
15947req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15948hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15949 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15950 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15951 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15952 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15953 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15954 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15955 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15956
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015957req.ungrpc(<field_number>) : binary
15958 This extracts the protocol buffers message in raw mode of a gRPC request body
15959 with <field_number> as terminal field number (dotted notation).
15960
15961 Example:
15962 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15963 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15964
15965 message Point {
15966 int32 latitude = 1;
15967 int32 longitude = 2;
15968 }
15969
15970 message PPoint {
15971 Point point = 59;
15972 }
15973
15974 message Rectangle {
15975 // One corner of the rectangle.
15976 PPoint lo = 48;
15977 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15978 PPoint hi = 49;
15979 }
15980
15981 Let's say a body requests is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15982 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers messages could be fetched
15983 with this "req.ungrpc" sample fetch directives:
15984
15985 req.ungrpc(48.59.1) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15986 req.ungrpc(48.59.2) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15987 req.ungrpc(49.59.1) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
15988 req.ungrpc(49.59.2) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15989
15990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15992 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15993 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15994 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15995 basic auth is supported.
15996
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015997http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15998 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15999 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16000 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16001 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16003 basic auth is supported.
16004
16005 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016006 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16007 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16008 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16009 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010
16011http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016012 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16013 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16015 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017method : integer + string
16018 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16019 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16020 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16021 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16022 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16023 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16024 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026 ACL derivatives :
16027 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029 Example :
16030 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16031 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16032 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034path : string
16035 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16036 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16037 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16038 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16039 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016040 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043 ACL derivatives :
16044 path : exact string match
16045 path_beg : prefix match
16046 path_dir : subdir match
16047 path_dom : domain match
16048 path_end : suffix match
16049 path_len : length match
16050 path_reg : regex match
16051 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016052
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016053query : string
16054 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16055 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16056 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16057 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016058 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016059 which stops before the question mark.
16060
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016061req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16062 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16063 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16064 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16065 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067req.ver : string
16068req_ver : string (deprecated)
16069 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16070 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16071 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073 ACL derivatives :
16074 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076res.comp : boolean
16077 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16078 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16079 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081res.comp_algo : string
16082 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16083 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16084 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086res.cook([<name>]) : string
16087scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16088 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16089 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16090 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092 ACL derivatives :
16093 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16096scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16097 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16098 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16099 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16102scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16103 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16104 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16105 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16108 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16109 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16110 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16111 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16112 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16113 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16114 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16115 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16116 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16119 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16120 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16121 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16122 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16123 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16126shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16127 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16128 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16129 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16130 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16131 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16132 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16133 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16134 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 ACL derivatives :
16137 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16138 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16139 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16140 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16141 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16142 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16143 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16144 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16145
16146res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16147shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16148 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16149 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16150 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16151 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16152 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16155shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16156 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16157 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16158 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16159 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16160 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16161 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016162
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016163res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16164 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16165 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16166 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16167 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16170shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16171 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16172 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16173 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16174 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16175 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16176 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178res.ver : string
16179resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16180 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16181 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 ACL derivatives :
16184 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16187 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16188 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016189 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16193 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195status : integer
16196 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16197 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16198 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016199
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016200unique-id : string
16201 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16202 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16203 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16204 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16205 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16206 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208url : string
16209 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16210 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16211 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16212 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16213 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16214 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16215 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217 ACL derivatives :
16218 url : exact string match
16219 url_beg : prefix match
16220 url_dir : subdir match
16221 url_dom : domain match
16222 url_end : suffix match
16223 url_len : length match
16224 url_reg : regex match
16225 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227url_ip : ip
16228 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16229 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16230 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16231 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16232 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16233 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16234 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236url_port : integer
16237 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16238 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16239 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16240 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016241
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016242urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16243url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16245 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016246 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16247 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16248 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16249 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16251 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016252 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16253 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 ACL derivatives :
16256 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16257 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16258 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16259 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16260 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16261 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16262 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16263 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016264
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 Example :
16267 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16268 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16269 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16270 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016271
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016272urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16274 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16275 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016276
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016277url32 : integer
16278 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16279 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16280 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16281 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16282 is an unsigned integer.
16283
16284url32+src : binary
16285 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16286 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16287 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16288
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016291---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016293Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16294every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016295order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016297ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16298---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016299FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016300HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016301HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16302HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016303HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16304HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16305HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16306HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16307LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016308METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016309METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016310METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16311METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16312METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16313METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016314METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016315METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016316RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016317REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016318TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016319WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16320---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016321
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163238. Logging
16324----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016326One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16327provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16328very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16329provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16330state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016331to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332headers.
16333
16334In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16335about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16336send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16337
16338 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16339 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16340 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16341 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16342 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016343 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016344 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016345
16346The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16347allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16348as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16349while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16350real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16351delay.
16352
16353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163548.1. Log levels
16355---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016356
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016357TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016358source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016359HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16360in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16361track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16362syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16363about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016364
16365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163668.2. Log formats
16367----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016368
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016369HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016370and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16371slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16372options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016373
16374 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16375 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16376 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16377 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16378 extents.
16379
16380 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16381 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16382 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16383 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16384 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16385
16386 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16387 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16388 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16389 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16390 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16391
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016392 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16393 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16394 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16395 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16396
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016397 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16398
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016399Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16400specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16401field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16402servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16403always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16404identifier.
16405
16406Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16407 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16408 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16409 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16410 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16411
16412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164138.2.1. Default log format
16414-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016415
16416This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16417as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16418format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16419
16420 Example :
16421 listen www
16422 mode http
16423 log global
16424 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16425
16426 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16427 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16428 (www/HTTP)
16429
16430 Field Format Extract from the example above
16431 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16432 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16433 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16434 4 'to' to
16435 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16436 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16437
16438Detailed fields description :
16439 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16440 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16441 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16442 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16443 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16444 and processed the connection.
16445 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16446
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016447In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16448"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16449connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016451It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16452will eventually disappear.
16453
16454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164558.2.2. TCP log format
16456---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016457
16458The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16459is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16460information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16461counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16462emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16463environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16464the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16465sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016466specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16467not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16468fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16469marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016470
16471 Example :
16472 frontend fnt
16473 mode tcp
16474 option tcplog
16475 log global
16476 default_backend bck
16477
16478 backend bck
16479 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16480
16481 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16482 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16483 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16484
16485 Field Format Extract from the example above
16486 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16487 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16488 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16489 4 frontend_name fnt
16490 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16491 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16492 7 bytes_read* 212
16493 8 termination_state --
16494 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16495 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16496
16497Detailed fields description :
16498 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016499 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16500 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16501 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016502 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016503 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016504 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016505
16506 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016507 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16508 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16509 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16512 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16513 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016514 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16515 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16516 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16517 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016518
16519 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16520 and processed the connection.
16521
16522 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16523 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16524 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16525 applications.
16526
16527 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16528 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16529 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16530 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16531 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16532
16533 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16534 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16535 See "Timers" below for more details.
16536
16537 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16538 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16539 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16540 "Timers" below for more details.
16541
16542 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016543 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16545 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16546 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16547 details.
16548
16549 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16550 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16551 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16552 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16553 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16554
16555 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16556 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16557 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16558 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16559 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16560 for more details.
16561
16562 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016563 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016564 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16565 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16566 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016567 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016568
16569 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16570 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16571 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16572 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16573 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16574 caused by a denial of service attack.
16575
16576 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16577 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16578 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16579 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16580 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16581 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16582 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16583 denial of service attack.
16584
16585 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16586 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16587 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16588 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16589 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16590 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16591 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16592 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16593 be processed than on other servers.
16594
16595 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16596 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16597 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16598 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16599 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16600 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16601 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16602 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16603 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16604 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16605 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16606 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16607 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16608
16609 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16610 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16611 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16612 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16613 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16614 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016615 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16617
16618 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16619 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16620 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16621 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16622 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16623 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016624 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16626 occurs.
16627
16628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166298.2.3. HTTP log format
16630----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016631
16632The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16633is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16634the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16635are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16636emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16637generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16638"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16639which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016640frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16641is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642
16643Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16644slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16645with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16646
16647 Example :
16648 frontend http-in
16649 mode http
16650 option httplog
16651 log global
16652 default_backend bck
16653
16654 backend static
16655 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16656
16657 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16658 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16659 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016660 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016661
16662 Field Format Extract from the example above
16663 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16664 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016665 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666 4 frontend_name http-in
16667 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016668 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669 7 status_code 200
16670 8 bytes_read* 2750
16671 9 captured_request_cookie -
16672 10 captured_response_cookie -
16673 11 termination_state ----
16674 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16675 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16676 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16677 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16678 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016679
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016680Detailed fields description :
16681 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016682 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16683 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16684 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016685 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016686 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016687 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688
16689 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016690 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16691 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16692 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016693
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016694 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16695 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
16697 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16698 and processed the connection.
16699
16700 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16701 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16702 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16703
16704 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16705 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16706 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16707 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16708 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16709 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16710
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016711 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16712 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16713 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16714 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16715 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16716 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016717 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16718 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016719
16720 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16721 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016722 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016723
16724 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16725 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016726 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16727 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016728
16729 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16730 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16731 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16732 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16733 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016734 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16735 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016737 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16738 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16739 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16740 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16741 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16742 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16743 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016744 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016745
16746 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16747 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16748 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16749
16750 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16751 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16752 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16753 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16754 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16755 overflowing.
16756
16757 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16758 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16759 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16760 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16761 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16762 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16763 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16764 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16765
16766 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16767 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16768 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16769 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16770 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16771 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16772 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16773 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16774
16775 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16776 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16777 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16778 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16779 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16780 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16781 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16782
16783 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016784 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016785 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16786 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16787 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016788 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016789 system.
16790
16791 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16792 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16793 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16794 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16795 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16796 caused by a denial of service attack.
16797
16798 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16799 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16800 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16801 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16802 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16803 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16804 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16805 denial of service attack.
16806
16807 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16808 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16809 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16810 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16811 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16812 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16813 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16814 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16815 processed than on other servers.
16816
16817 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16818 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16819 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16820 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16821 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16822 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16823 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16824 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16825 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16826 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16827 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16828 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16829 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16830
16831 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16832 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16833 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16834 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16835 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16836 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016837 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016838 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16839
16840 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16841 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16842 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16843 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16844 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16845 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016846 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016847 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16848 occurs.
16849
16850 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16851 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16852 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16853 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16854 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16855 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16856 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16857 cookies" below for more details.
16858
16859 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16860 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16861 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16862 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16863 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16864 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16865 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16866 and cookies" below for more details.
16867
16868 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16869 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16870 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16871 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16872 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16873 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16874 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16875 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16876
16877
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168788.2.4. Custom log format
16879------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016880
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016881The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016882mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016884HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016885Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16886separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16887prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16888
16889Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16890variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016891("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016892
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016893If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016894as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016895less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16896the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16897
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016898Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016899In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016900in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016901
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016902Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16903'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16904https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16905such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16906
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016907Flags are :
16908 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016909 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016910 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16911 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016912
16913 Example:
16914
16915 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16916 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16917
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016918 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16919
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016920At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016922 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16923 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016924
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016925the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016926
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016927 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16928 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16929 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016930
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016931and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16932
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016933 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16934 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016935
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016936Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16937
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016938 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016939 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016940 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16941 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16942 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016943 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16944 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16945 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016946 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016947 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16948 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016949 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016950 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16951 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016952 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016953 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016954 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016955 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016956 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016957 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016958 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016959 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16960 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16961 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16962 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16963 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016964 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016965 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16966 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016967 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016968 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16969 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016970 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16971 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16972 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016973 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016974 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16975 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016976 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016977 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16978 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16979 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016980 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016981 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016982 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16983 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16984 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16985 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016986 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016987 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016988 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016989 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016990 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016991 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016992 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16993 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16994 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016995 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016996 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16997 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016998 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016999 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17000 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017001 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017002 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017003 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017004 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017005
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017006 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017007
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017008
170098.2.5. Error log format
17010-----------------------
17011
17012When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17013protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17014By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17015"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017016will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017017logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17018
17019The format looks like this :
17020
17021 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17022 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17023 Connection error during SSL handshake
17024
17025 Field Format Extract from the example above
17026 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17027 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17028 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17029 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17030 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17031
17032These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17033failures.
17034
17035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170368.3. Advanced logging options
17037-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17040just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17041options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17042for more information about their usage.
17043
17044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170458.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17046------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017047
17048It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17049haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17050commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17051monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17052ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17053
17054 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17055 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17056 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17057 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17058
17059 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17060 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17061 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017062 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063 such as other load-balancers.
17064
17065 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17066 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17067 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17068
17069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170708.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17071----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072
17073The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17074what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17075or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017076"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17078log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17079after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17080is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17081with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17082with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17083
17084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17086------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017087
17088Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17089for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17090"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17091retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17092raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17093a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17094file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17095you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17096"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17097
17098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17100--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017101
17102Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17103multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17104them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17105"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17106logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17107error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17108and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17109too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17110useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17111alternative.
17112
17113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171148.4. Timing events
17115------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017116
17117Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17118reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17119the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17120frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017121mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17122addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17123
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017124Timings events in HTTP mode:
17125
17126 first request 2nd request
17127 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17128 t tr t tr ...
17129 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17130 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17131 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17132 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17133 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17134
17135Timings events in TCP mode:
17136
17137 TCP session
17138 |<----------------->|
17139 t t
17140 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17141 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17142 |<------ Tt ------->|
17143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017144 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017145 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017146 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17147 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17148 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017149 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017150 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17151 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17152 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17153 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017155 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17156 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17157 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017158 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17159 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17160 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17161 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17162 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17163 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017164
17165 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17166 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17167 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17168 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17169 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17170 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17171 request typed by hand during a test.
17172
17173 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17174 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017175 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017176 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17177 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17178 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17179 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180
17181 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17182 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17183 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17184 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17185 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17186
17187 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17188 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17189 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17190 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17191 connection never established.
17192
17193 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17194 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17195 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17196 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17197 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17198 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17199 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17200 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17201 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17202 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17203 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17204
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017205 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17206 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17207 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17208 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17209 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17210 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17211
17212 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17213
17214 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17215 "Ta" can never be negative.
17216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17218 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017219 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17220 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017221 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017223 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017224
17225 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017226 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17227 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228
17229These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17230protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17231that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017232due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17233"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17234that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235
17236Most common cases :
17237
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017238 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17239 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17240 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17241 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17242 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17243 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17244 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17245 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17246 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17247 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17248 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017249 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017250
17251 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17252 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17253 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17254 of ms on remote networks.
17255
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017256 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17257 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17258 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017259
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017260 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17261 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17262 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17263 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17264 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17265 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17266 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17267 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17268 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269
17270Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17271
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017272 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017274 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017275
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017276 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017277 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17278 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017280 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17282 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17283 flags.
17284
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017285 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17286 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17288 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17289 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17290 the client connection was maintained open.
17291
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017292 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017293 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017294 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17296
17297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172988.5. Session state at disconnection
17299-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300
17301TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17302"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173032-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17304each of which has a special meaning :
17305
17306 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17307 session to terminate :
17308
17309 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17310
17311 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17312 server explicitly refused it.
17313
17314 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17315 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17316 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17317 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017319
17320 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17321 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017322
17323 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17324 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17325 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17326 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17327 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17328
17329 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17330 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17331 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17332 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17333 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17334
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017335 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17336 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17337
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017338 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17339 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17340 backup connections when going up.
17341
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017342 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17345 send or receive data.
17346
17347 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17348 send or receive data.
17349
17350 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17351 with nothing left in the buffers.
17352
17353 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17354
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017355 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017356 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17357
17358 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17359 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17360 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17361 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17362 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17363
17364 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17365 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17366
17367 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17368 server (HTTP only).
17369
17370 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17371
17372 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17373 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17374 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17375
17376 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17377 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17378 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17379
17380 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17381
17382 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17383 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17384
17385 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17386 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17387 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17388
17389 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17390 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017391 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17392 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017393
17394 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17395 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17396 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17397 another server.
17398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017399 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017400 server.
17401
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017402 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17403 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17404 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17405 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17406
17407 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17408 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17409 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17410 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17411
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017412 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17413 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17414 "use-server" rule).
17415
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017416 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17417
17418 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17419 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17420
17421 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17422
17423 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17424 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17425 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17426
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017427 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17428 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017429 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017430 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17431 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17432
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017433 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17434
17435 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17436 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17437
17438 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17439
17440 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17441
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017442The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17443was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17445starvation, attacks, etc...
17446
17447The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17448alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17449easier finding and understanding.
17450
17451 Flags Reason
17452
17453 -- Normal termination.
17454
17455 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17456 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17457 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17458 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17459
17460 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17461 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17462 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17463 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17464 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17465 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017467 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17468 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017469 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470
17471 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17472 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17473 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17474
17475 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17476 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17477 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17478 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17479 the server takes too long to respond.
17480
17481 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17482 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17483 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17484 long a time to respond.
17485
17486 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17487 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17488 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17489 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017490 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17491 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017492
17493 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17494 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17495 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17496 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17497 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017498 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017499 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17500 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17501 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17502 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17503 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17504 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17505 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17506 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017507 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017508 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17509 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17510 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
17512 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17513 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017514 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17515 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17516 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17517 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017518
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017519 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17520 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017522 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017523 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17524 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017525 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017526 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17527 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17528
17529 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17530 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17531 503 or 504 here.
17532
17533 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17534 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17535 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17536 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17537 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17538
17539 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17540 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017541 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17543 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17544
17545 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17546 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17547 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17548 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17549 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17550 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17551 between haproxy and the server.
17552
17553 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17554 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17555 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17556 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17557 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17558 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17559 solution is to fix the application.
17560
17561 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17562 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17563 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17564 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17565 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17566 external attacks.
17567
17568 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17569 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017570 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017571 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17572 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17573
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017574 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17575 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17576 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017577 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017578 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017579
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017580 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17581 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17582 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17583 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017584 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17585 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17586 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17587 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17588 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017589
17590 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17591 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17592 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17593 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17594
17595 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17596 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17597 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17598 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17599
17600 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17601 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17602 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17603 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17604
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017605The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17606persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17607important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17608re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17609
17610 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17611
17612 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17613 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17614 set on a GET request.
17615
17616 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17617 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017618 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017619 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17620
17621 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17622 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17623 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17624
17625 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17626 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17627 already got a cookie.
17628
17629 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17630 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17631 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17632 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17633 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17634
17635 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17636 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17637 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17638
17639 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17640 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17641 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17642
17643 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17644 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17645
17646 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17647 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17648 then advertised in the response.
17649
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176518.6. Non-printable characters
17652-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017653
17654In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17655consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17656converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17657prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17658being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17659escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17660is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17661'}' when logging headers.
17662
17663Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17664issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17665containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17666
17667Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17668the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17669performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17670
17671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176728.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17673---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017674
17675Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17676achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017677section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017678cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17679the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17680the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017681locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017682not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17683user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17684a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17685wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17686
17687 Examples :
17688 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17689 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17690
17691 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17692 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17693
17694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176958.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17696---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
17698Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17699proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17700the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17701server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17702
17703Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17704response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017705section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706
17707It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017708time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17709appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017710are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17711and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17712follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17713request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17714in the logs.
17715
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017716As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17717frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17718an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720 Example :
17721 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17722 listen proxy-out
17723 mode http
17724 option httplog
17725 option logasap
17726 log global
17727 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17728
17729 # log the name of the virtual server
17730 capture request header Host len 20
17731
17732 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17733 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17734
17735 # log the beginning of the referrer
17736 capture request header Referer len 20
17737
17738 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17739 capture response header Server len 20
17740
17741 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17742 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017744 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017745 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17746
17747 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17748 capture response header Via len 20
17749
17750 # log the URL location during a redirection
17751 capture response header Location len 20
17752
17753 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17754 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17755 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17756 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17757 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17758
17759 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17760 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17761 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17762 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017763 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017764
17765 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17766 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17767 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17768 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17769 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017770 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017771
17772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177738.9. Examples of logs
17774---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017775
17776These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17777them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17778reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17779
17780 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17781 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17782 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17783
17784 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17785 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17786
17787 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17788 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17789 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17790
17791 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17792 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17793
17794 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17795 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17796 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17797
17798 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017799 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17801 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17802
17803 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17804 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17805 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17806
17807 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17808 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017809 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17811 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17812 to return the 502 and not the server.
17813
17814 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017815 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017816
17817 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17818 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17819 Nothing was sent to any server.
17820
17821 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17822 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17823
17824 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17825 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017826 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017827 send a 408 return code to the client.
17828
17829 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17830 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17831
17832 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17833 5 seconds ("c----").
17834
17835 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17836 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017837 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017838
17839 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017840 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17842 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17843 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17844 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17845 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017846
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017847
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178489. Supported filters
17849--------------------
17850
17851Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17852accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17853unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17854
17855See also : "filter"
17856
178579.1. Trace
17858----------
17859
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017860filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017861
17862 Arguments:
17863 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17864 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17865
17866 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17867 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17868 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17869 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17870
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017871 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017872 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17873 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17874 amount of the parsed data.
17875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017876 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017877
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017878This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17879callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17880information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17881filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17882
17883Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17884tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17885a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17886
17887
178889.2. HTTP compression
17889---------------------
17890
17891filter compression
17892
17893The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17894keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017895when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17896it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17897response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17898line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17899cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17900the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017901
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017902See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017903
17904
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179059.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17906--------------------------------------------
17907
17908filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17909
17910 Arguments :
17911
17912 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17913 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17914 parsed.
17915
17916 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17917 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17918 part must be placed in its own scope.
17919
17920The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17921external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017922streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017923exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17924also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17925
17926SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17927the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17928
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017929For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017930"doc/SPOE.txt".
17931
17932Important note:
17933 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17934 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17935
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179369.4. Cache
17937----------
17938
17939filter cache <name>
17940
17941 Arguments :
17942
17943 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17944
17945The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17946"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17947cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017948other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17949the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17950mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17951filter other than the compression is used for the same
17952listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17953order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017954
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017955See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017956
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001795710. Cache
17958---------
17959
17960HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17961(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17962RAM.
17963
17964The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017965this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017966
17967If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17968independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17969when we try to allocate a new one.
17970
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017971The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017972
17973It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17974"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17975for more details.
17976
17977When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17978replaced by "<CACHE>".
17979
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001798010.1. Limitation
17981----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017982
17983The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17984
17985- If the response is not a 200
17986- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017987- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017988- If the response is not cacheable
17989
17990- If the request is not a GET
17991- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017992- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017993
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017994Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17995filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17996can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17997example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17998"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017999
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800010.2. Setup
18001-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018002
18003To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18004the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18005
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800610.2.1. Cache section
18007---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018008
18009cache <name>
18010 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18011 size of cache is mandatory.
18012
18013total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018014 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018015 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018016
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018017max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018018 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18019 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18020 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018021
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018022max-age <seconds>
18023 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18024 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18025 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18026 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18027 default.
18028
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802910.2.2. Proxy section
18030---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018031
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018032http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018033 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18034 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18035 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18036 after this one.
18037
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018038http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018039 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18040 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18041 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18042 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18043
18044
18045Example:
18046
18047 backend bck1
18048 mode http
18049
18050 http-request cache-use foobar
18051 http-response cache-store foobar
18052 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18053
18054 cache foobar
18055 total-max-size 4
18056 max-age 240
18057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018058/*
18059 * Local variables:
18060 * fill-column: 79
18061 * End:
18062 */